-----BEGIN PRIVACY-ENHANCED MESSAGE-----
Proc-Type: 2001,MIC-CLEAR
Originator-Name: webmaster@www.sec.gov
Originator-Key-Asymmetric:
MFgwCgYEVQgBAQICAf8DSgAwRwJAW2sNKK9AVtBzYZmr6aGjlWyK3XmZv3dTINen
TWSM7vrzLADbmYQaionwg5sDW3P6oaM5D3tdezXMm7z1T+B+twIDAQAB
MIC-Info: RSA-MD5,RSA,
SHxPL90tocANrCB9uigcV6xst5DVH4XnkPO2izS6e1Ngi0ahGlr0t7gGphpytsGs
KKaRrIHvU5nOb8aFJR39WA==
<SEC-DOCUMENT>0000078890-03-000011.txt : 20030326
<SEC-HEADER>0000078890-03-000011.hdr.sgml : 20030325
<ACCEPTANCE-DATETIME>20030326172422
ACCESSION NUMBER: 0000078890-03-000011
CONFORMED SUBMISSION TYPE: 10-K
PUBLIC DOCUMENT COUNT: 12
CONFORMED PERIOD OF REPORT: 20021231
FILED AS OF DATE: 20030326
FILER:
COMPANY DATA:
COMPANY CONFORMED NAME: PITTSTON CO
CENTRAL INDEX KEY: 0000078890
STANDARD INDUSTRIAL CLASSIFICATION: BITUMINOUS COAL & LIGNITE MINING [1220]
IRS NUMBER: 541317776
STATE OF INCORPORATION: VA
FISCAL YEAR END: 1231
FILING VALUES:
FORM TYPE: 10-K
SEC ACT: 1934 Act
SEC FILE NUMBER: 001-09148
FILM NUMBER: 03619015
BUSINESS ADDRESS:
STREET 1: 1801 BAYBERRY COURT
STREET 2: P O BOX 18100
CITY: RICHMOND
STATE: VA
ZIP: 23058-4229
BUSINESS PHONE: 8045533681
MAIL ADDRESS:
STREET 1: 1801 BAYBERRY COURT
STREET 2: P O BOX 18100
CITY: RICHMOND
STATE: VA
ZIP: 23226-8100
</SEC-HEADER>
<DOCUMENT>
<TYPE>10-K
<SEQUENCE>1
<FILENAME>form10k2002.txt
<DESCRIPTION>2002 FORM 10-K
<TEXT>
UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
WASHINGTON, DC 20549
FORM 10-K
(MARK ONE)
X ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15 (d) OF THE
SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934 FOR THE FISCAL YEAR ENDED
DECEMBER 31, 2002
OR
TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(D) OF THE SECURITIES
EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
FOR THE TRANSITION PERIOD FROM ____________ TO ____________
COMMISSION FILE NUMBER 1-9148
THE PITTSTON COMPANY
(EXACT NAME OF REGISTRANT AS SPECIFIED IN ITS CHARTER)
VIRGINIA 54-1317776
(STATE OR OTHER JURISDICTION OF (IRS EMPLOYER
INCORPORATION OR ORGANIZATION) IDENTIFICATION NO.)
P.O. BOX 18100,
1801 BAYBERRY COURT
RICHMOND, VIRGINIA 23226-8100
(ADDRESS OF PRINCIPAL EXECUTIVE OFFICES) (ZIP CODE)
REGISTRANT'S TELEPHONE NUMBER, INCLUDING AREA CODE (804) 289-9600
SECURITIES REGISTERED PURSUANT TO SECTION 12(B) OF THE ACT:
NAME OF EXCHANGE ON
TITLE OF EACH CLASS WHICH REGISTERED
PITTSTON BRINK'S GROUP COMMON STOCK, PAR VALUE $1 NEW YORK STOCK EXCHANGE
RIGHTS TO PURCHASE SERIES A PARTICIPATING NEW YORK STOCK EXCHANGE
CUMULATIVE PREFERRED STOCK
SECURITIES REGISTERED PURSUANT TO SECTION 12(G) OF THE ACT: NONE
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant: (1) has filed all
reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange
Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months and (2) has been subject to such
filing requirements for the past 90 days.
Yes X No
Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to
Item 405 of Regulation S-K is not contained herein, and will not be contained,
to the best of registrant's knowledge, in definitive proxy or information
statements incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any
amendment to this Form 10-K. X
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is an accelerated filer
(as defined in Exchange Act Rule 12b-2).
Yes X No
As of March 1, 2003, there were issued and outstanding 54,253,423
shares of common stock. The aggregate market value of shares of common stock
held by nonaffiliates, as of June 28, 2002, was $1,237,810,008.
Documents incorporated by reference: Part I, Part II and Part IV
incorporate information by reference from the Annual Report of the Company for
the year ended December 31, 2002. Part III incorporates information by reference
from portions of the Registrant's definitive Proxy Statement to be filed
pursuant to Regulation 14A.
<PAGE>
PART I
ITEMS 1 AND 2. BUSINESS AND PROPERTIES
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
THE PITTSTON COMPANY
The Pittston Company, a Virginia corporation incorporated in 1930, has three
primary operating segments within its "Business and Security Services"
businesses: Brink's, Incorporated ("Brink's"); Brink's Home Security, Inc.
("BHS"); and BAX Global Inc. ("BAX Global").
The fourth operating segment is Other Operations, which consists of gold, timber
and natural gas operations. The Company also has significant assets and
liabilities associated with its former coal operations and expects to have
significant ongoing expenses and cash outflows related to former coal operations
in the future.
The Pittston Company and its subsidiaries are referred to herein as the
"Company". The Company's common stock trades on the New York Stock Exchange
under the symbol "PZB."
Financial information related to the Company's operating segments is included in
Note 2 to the Consolidated Financial Statements in the Company's 2002 Annual
Report, which Note is herein incorporated by reference.
The Company has approximately 50,000 employees in its Business and Security
Services operations, including approximately 37,500 at Brink's, 2,500 at BHS and
10,000 at BAX Global.
A significant portion of the Company's business is conducted outside the United
States. Because the financial results of the Company are reported in U.S.
dollars, they are affected by changes in the value of the various foreign
currencies in relation to the U.S. dollar. The Company, from time to time, uses
foreign currency forward contracts to hedge certain transactional risks
associated with foreign currencies. The Company is also subject to other risks
customarily associated with doing business in foreign countries, including labor
and economic conditions, political instability, controls on repatriation of
earnings and capital, nationalization, expropriation and other forms of
restrictive action by local governments. The future effects of such risks on the
Company cannot be predicted.
The Pittston Company's internet address is www.pittston.com. The Company makes
available, free of charge, through its website, its Annual Report on Form 10-K,
quarterly reports on Form 10-Q, current reports on Form 8-K and amendments to
those reports filed or furnished pursuant to Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the
Exchange Act as soon as reasonably practicable after the Company electronically
files such information with or furnishes it to the Securities and Exchange
Commission.
BUSINESS AND SECURITY SERVICES
BRINK'S, INCORPORATED ("BRINK'S")
GENERAL
The major services offered by Brink's include armored car transportation,
automated teller machine ("ATM") servicing, currency and deposit processing,
coin sorting and wrapping, arranging the secure air transportation of valuables
("Global Services") and the deploying and servicing of safes and safe control
devices, including its patented CompuSafe(R) service. Brink's serves customers
through 154 branches in the U.S. and 41 branches in Canada. Service is also
provided through subsidiaries, equity affiliates and associated companies in 48
countries outside the U.S. and Canada. Brink's ownership interest in
subsidiaries and affiliated companies ranges from 20% to 100%. In some instances
local laws limit the extent of Brink's ownership interest.
Brink's customers include banks; industrial, retail and other commercial
businesses; investment banking and brokerage firms; and government agencies,
such as a country's central bank. Brink's provides individualized services under
separate contracts designed to meet the distinct transportation, security and
logistics requirements of its customers. These contracts are usually for an
initial term of one year or less, but continue in effect thereafter until
canceled by either party.
Brink's armored car transportation services generally include secure
transportation of:
o Cash from businesses to banks for deposit.
o Cash, securities and other negotiable items and valuables between commercial
banks, central banks (such as the U.S. Federal Reserve Banks and their
branches and correspondents) and brokerage firms.
o New currency, coins and precious metals for a number of central banks
throughout the world.
o Canceled checks between banks or between a clearing house and its member banks
in certain geographic areas.
In late 2001 and early 2002, Brink's participated in the initial distribution of
the euro in Europe.
The trend by banks, retail businesses and others to outsource vaulting and cash
room operations continued in 2002. Brink's provides coin and currency processing
("cash logistics") services primarily to banks and retail customers. Retail
customers use Brink's cash logistics services to count and reconcile coins and
currency in Brink's secure environment, to prepare bank deposit information and
to replenish retail locations' coins and currency in proper denominations.
-1-
<PAGE>
Through its proprietary cash processing and information systems, Brink's offers
customers the ability to integrate a full range of cash vault, ATM,
transportation, storage, processing, inventory management and reporting
services. Brink's believes that its cash processing and information systems
differentiate its cash logistics services from its competitors.
For transporting money and other valuables over long distances, Brink's Global
Services offers a combined armored car and secure air transportation service
between many cities around the world. Brink's uses regularly scheduled or
chartered aircraft in connection with its air courier services. Included in
Global Services is a worldwide specialized diamond and jewelry secure
transportation operation, with offices in the major diamond and jewelry centers
of the world.
Brink's CompuSafe(R) services provide retail customers with a proprietary
integrated system of safeguarding and managing cash. Brink's markets its
CompuSafe(R) services to a variety of cash-intensive retail customers, such as
convenience stores, gas stations and restaurants. The service includes
installing a specialized safe in the retail establishment that holds safeguarded
canisters. The customer's employees deposit currency into the canister. The
canister can only be removed by Brink's armored car personnel.
Brink's International operations accounted for approximately 56% of its revenues
and 46% of its operating profits in 2002. Brink's has International operations
in three regions: Europe, South America and Asia/Pacific.
COMPETITION
Brink's is the oldest and largest armored car service company in the U.S. as
well as a market leader in many of the countries in which it operates.
Worldwide, Brink's competes with a number of large multinational companies and
with many smaller companies.
Primary factors in attracting and retaining customers are security, the quality
of services provided and the price charged for services rendered. Brink's
believes its competitive advantages include:
o Recognizable name
o Reputation for a high level of service and security
o Proprietary cash processing and information systems
o High-quality insurance coverage
o Ability to serve multiple markets for the same customer in many of the
countries in which Brink's has operations
Brink's believes its cost structure is generally competitive, although Brink's
believes certain competitors may have lower costs as a result of lower wage and
benefit levels for employees or as a result of different security standards.
To reduce costs, financial institutions frequently use consultants and
purchasing and procurement professionals to negotiate price and frequency of
services with armored car companies. Brink's growth in sales to retail
businesses is partially dependent on the growth in the economy. Recent slow
economic growth has resulted in an increasing focus on the cost of armored car
services by retail customers. Because of Brink's high level of service and
security, and quality insurance coverage, Brink's resists competing on price
alone.
The availability of quality and reliable insurance coverage is an important
factor in the ability of Brink's to obtain and retain customers and to manage
the risks of its business. Brink's purchases "all risk" insurance coverage for
losses in excess of what it considers prudent deductibles and/or retentions. For
losses below deductible or retention levels, Brink's is self-insured. Brink's
insurance policies cover losses from most causes, with the exception of war,
nuclear risk and certain other exclusions typical for such policies. Brink's
generally does not offer its customers protection from losses arising from such
excluded causes.
Insurance is provided by different groups of underwriters at negotiated rates
and terms. Insurance is available to Brink's in major markets although the
premiums charged are subject to fluctuations depending on market conditions. The
loss experience of Brink's and, to a limited extent, other armored carriers
affects premium rates charged to Brink's.
SERVICE MARK, PATENTS AND COPYRIGHTS
BRINKS is a registered service mark in the U.S. and certain foreign countries.
The BRINKS mark, name and related marks are of material significance to Brink's
business. Brink's owns patents with respect to certain coin sorting and counting
machines, which expire in 2007 and 2008, respectively. Brink's has patents
associated with its integrated service, CompuSafe(R), that expire in 2015
through 2018. The patents for CompuSafe(R) and sorting and counting machines
provide important advantages to Brink's in their respective areas of business.
However, Brink's operations are not dependent on the existence of the
aforementioned patents.
The Company has entered into certain agreements to license the Brink's or the
Brink's Home Security name. Examples include licenses to distributors of
security products (padlocks, home safes, door and window hardware, etc.) offered
for sale to consumers through major retail chains.
GOVERNMENT REGULATION
The operations of Brink's are subject to regulation by the U.S. Department of
Transportation with respect to safety of operations and equipment and financial
responsibility. Intrastate operations in the U.S. and intraprovince operations
in Canada are subject to regulation by state and by Canadian and provincial
regulatory authorities, respectively. Brink's International operations are
regulated to varying degrees by the countries in which they operate.
EMPLOYEE RELATIONS
At December 31, 2002, Brink's and its subsidiaries had approximately 37,500
employees, including11,400 employees in North America, (of whom 2,000 were
classified as part-time employees) and 26,100 employees outside North America.
At
-2-
<PAGE>
December 31, 2002, Brink's was a party to 14 collective bargaining agreements
in North America with various local unions covering approximately 1,500
employees, almost all of whom are employees in Canada and members of unions
affiliated with the International Brotherhood of Teamsters. Negotiations are
continuing on one agreement that has expired and three agreements expiring in
2003. The remaining agreements will expire after 2003. Outside of North America,
the branch workforce are members of labor or employee organizations in the
majority of the countries of operation. Brink's believes that its employee
relations are satisfactory.
PROPERTIES
In North America, Brink's owns 29 branch offices and leases an additional 166
branch offices, located in 39 states, the District of Columbia and nine Canadian
provinces. Such branches generally include office space and garage or vehicle
terminals. Of the leased branches, 121 facilities are held under long-term
leases. The remaining 45 branches are held under short-term leases or
month-to-month tenancies. Brink's corporate headquarters facility in Darien,
Connecticut, is held under a lease expiring in 2005.
In North America, Brink's owns or leases approximately 2,400 armored vehicles,
300 panel trucks and 200 other vehicles that are primarily service vehicles.
Brink's armored vehicles are of bullet-resistant construction and are specially
designed and equipped to afford security for crew and cargo.
Brink's subsidiaries and affiliated and associated companies located outside
North America operate from approximately 500 branches, the majority of which are
leased, with approximately 4,600 owned or leased armored vehicles.
Approximately 4,000 Brink's-owned CompuSafe(R) devices are located on customers'
premises in North America.
BRINK'S HOME SECURITY ("BHS")
GENERAL
BHS believes that it is the second largest provider of monitored security
services to single family residences in North America. BHS is primarily engaged
in the business of marketing, selling, installing, monitoring and servicing
electronic security systems in owner-occupied, single-family residences. At
December 31, 2002, BHS had approximately 767,000 systems under monitoring
contracts, including approximately 106,000 new subscribers added during the
year. BHS provides services to subscribers located in more than 250 metropolitan
areas in 43 states, the District of Columbia and two western provinces in
Canada.
BHS' typical security system installation consists of sensors and other devices
which are installed at a customer's home. The equipment can be configured to
signal intrusion, fire, medical and other alerts. When an alarm is triggered, a
signal is sent by telephone line to BHS' central monitoring station in Irving,
Texas. The monitoring station holds an Underwriters' Laboratories, Inc. ("UL")
listing. UL specifications for service centers include building integrity,
back-up computer and power systems, staffing and standard operating procedures.
In the event of an emergency, such as fire, tornado, major interruption in
telephone or computer service, or any other event affecting the Irving facility,
monitoring operations can be transferred to a backup facility located in
Carrollton, Texas.
BHS markets its alarm systems primarily through TV and direct mail advertising,
yellow page advertising, alliances with other service companies, inbound
telemarketing and field sales employees. BHS employees install and service most
of the systems; however, subcontractors are utilized on occasion in some service
areas. BHS does not manufacture the equipment used in its security systems.
Equipment is purchased from a limited number of suppliers and no interruptions
in supply are expected. Equipment inventories are maintained at each branch
office.
BHS has an authorized dealer program to expand its geographic coverage and
leverage its national advertising. The dealer program accounted for less than 9%
of new installations during 2002 and, as of December 31, 2002, less than 3% of
BHS' total subscriber base. Approximately 67 dealers were authorized to
participate in the program as of December 31, 2002. BHS requires that its
dealers install the same type of equipment as is installed by its own branches,
and adhere to the same installation quality standards.
In addition to initiating subscriber relationships through its branch and dealer
networks, BHS obtains new residential subscribers through its Brink's Home
Technologies division. Brink's Home Technologies markets residential security
systems, as well as a variety of low-voltage security, home networking,
communications and entertainment options, directly to major home builders.
BHS also provides monitored security to residents of apartment and condominium
complexes; however, such customers currently represent less than 2% of
subscribers.
Although its core business is focused on the monitoring of residential security
systems, BHS installs and monitors commercial security systems on a limited
basis. Such customers represent approximately 4% of subscribers.
GOVERNMENT REGULATION
BHS and its employees are subject to various federal, state and local consumer
protection, licensing and other laws and regulations. BHS' business relies upon
the use of telephone lines to communicate signals, and telephone companies are
currently regulated by both the Federal and state governments. Regulation of the
installation and monitoring of fire detection devices has also increased in
several local markets. BHS' wholly owned Canadian subsidiary, Brink's Home
Security Canada Limited, is subject to the laws of Canada, British Columbia and
Alberta.
The alarm service industry experiences a high incidence of false alarms. BHS
believes its false alarm rate compares favorably to other companies' rates. The
high incidence of false alarms in the industry has caused some local governments
to impose
-3-
<PAGE>
assessments, fines and penalties on either subscribers or the alarm
companies. A few municipalities are considering ordinances under which both
permit and alarm dispatch fees would be charged directly to the alarm companies.
BHS alarm service contracts allow BHS to pass these charges on to customers.
Police departments in two major western U.S. cities do not respond to calls from
alarm companies unless an emergency has been visually verified. If more police
departments in the future refuse to respond to calls from alarm companies
without visual verification, this could have an adverse effect on future results
of operations for BHS.
COMPETITION
BHS competes in most major metropolitan markets in the U.S. and several markets
in western Canada through branch operations or its authorized dealer program.
The home security market has a large number of competitors, including many local
and regional companies. Several of BHS' large competitors have placed a heavy
reliance on dealers and acquisitions to increase their subscriber bases, whereas
BHS has gained almost all of its subscribers through internal sales efforts. BHS
believes that it is now the second largest provider of monitored security
services to single-family residences in North America.
Competition is based on a variety of factors including, but not limited to,
price, product quality, company reputation and service quality. There has been
substantial competitive pressure on installation fees in recent years. Several
significant competitors offer installation prices which match or are less than
BHS' prices; however, many of the small local competitors in BHS' markets
continue to charge significantly more for installation. Competitive pressure on
monitoring rates, while less intense than on installation fees, is still
substantial. BHS believes that the monitoring rates it offers are generally
comparable to the rates offered by other major security companies.
BHS believes its customer retention rate is the highest among the major home
security service companies. BHS attributes its relatively high customer
retention rate to the high credit standards for new customers which reduces the
number of subsequent cancellations of service related to nonpayment. BHS also
believes it is more effective than the other major home security services
companies in the area of customer service, which tends to reduce customer
disconnects over time.
EMPLOYEES
BHS has approximately 2,500 employees, none of whom is covered by a collective
bargaining agreement. BHS believes that its employee relations are satisfactory.
PROPERTIES
BHS has approximately 55 leased offices and warehouse facilities located
throughout the U.S. and one leased office in Canada. The central monitoring
station in Irving, Texas is leased for a seven-year term ending in 2005,
including renewal options. This facility also serves as BHS' headquarters and
houses most administrative, technical and marketing services personnel. The
lease for the backup monitoring center in Carrollton, Texas, expires in 2005.
BHS leases approximately 1,300 vehicles which are used in the process of
installing and servicing its security systems.
BHS retains ownership of most of the approximately 767,000 systems currently
under contract. When a customer cancels monitoring services, BHS typically
disables the system. In a limited number of cases, BHS removes the equipment.
When a customer cancels monitoring services because of a move, the retention of
the BHS system in the residence facilitates the marketing of monitoring services
to the new homeowner.
BAX GLOBAL
GENERAL
BAX Global provides transportation and supply chain management services on a
global basis. BAX Global specializes in the heavy freight market for business to
business shipping.
BAX Global's transportation services are provided within North America using a
dedicated fleet of 20 planes with a national sorting hub in Toledo, Ohio. BAX
Global's North American operation also has a ground network that provides
transportation on a regional basis.
Outside North America, BAX Global provides transportation services using
available space on commercial carriers, and on occasion using chartered
aircraft. BAX Global's primary markets outside North America are shipping from
Asia to North America and Europe, and between North America and Europe.
BAX Global continues to expand its ocean shipping business primarily by
marketing its ocean products to its current air freight and supply chain
management customer base.
Air Transport International, LLC ("ATI"), a wholly owned subsidiary of BAX
Global, provides transportation services in North America to BAX Global and also
provides charter transportation services to other customers.
BAX Global provides certain transportation customers with supply chain
management services and operates more than 40 logistics warehouse and
distribution facilities in key world markets. BAX Global specializes in
developing supply chain management programs for companies entering new global
markets or consolidating regional activity.
TRANSPORTATION
BAX Global offers its North American (U.S., Canada and Mexico) transportation
customers a variety of products and pricing options, such as guaranteed and
standard overnight and second-day delivery as well as deferred delivery
(delivery generally within one to three business days). A variety of value-added
ancillary services, such as shipment tracking, inventory control and management
reports are also offered.
Outside North America, BAX Global offers a variety of services including
standard and expedited freight services, ocean forwarding, and door-to-door
delivery.
-4-
<PAGE>
BAX Global also frequently acts as customs broker, facilitating the clearance of
goods through customs at international points of entry. BAX Global has the
ability to link its international network with the North American transportation
infrastructure and customs brokerage capabilities to provide seamless
door-to-door delivery and distribution from global markets to virtually any city
in North America.
BAX Global sells its services primarily through its direct sales force. BAX
Global uses various marketing methods, including print media advertising and
direct marketing campaigns.
BAX Global generally picks up or receives freight shipments from its customers,
consolidates the freight of various customers into shipments for common
destinations and arranges for the transportation of the consolidated freight.
BAX Global uses either commercial carriers or, in the case of most of its North
American shipments, its own transportation fleet and regional and national hub
sorting facilities. BAX Global distributes the shipments at the package's
destination. While shipments move long distances on either common carrier or BAX
Global's fleet, the local pickup and delivery of freight are accomplished
principally by independent contractors using trucks dedicated to the BAX Global
network. BAX Global's independent contractors are required to display BAX
Global's logo and colors.
BAX Global has the ability to provide freight service to all North American
business communities as well as to virtually all countries through its network
of 500 company-operated stations and agent locations in 123 countries. BAX
Global's network is composed primarily of controlled subsidiaries and, to a
lesser extent, agents and sales representatives in many non-U.S. locations
typically under short-term contracts.
BAX Global's freight business is tied to the cycles of international trade, with
higher volumes of shipments from August through December than during the other
months of the year. The lowest volume of shipments generally occurs in January
and February.
Including U.S. export and import revenue, BAX Global's international shipments
and logistics services accounted for approximately 76% of its revenues in 2002.
Intra-U.S. shipments accounted for approximately 24% of total revenues in 2002.
BAX Global's network has a worldwide communications and information system which
provides global tracking and tracing of shipments and logistics data for
management information reports, enabling customers to improve efficiency and
control costs. BAX Global's customers are increasingly turning to its online
services offering information management available via its web site,
www.baxglobal.com.
SUPPLY CHAIN MANAGEMENT
BAX Global provides supply chain management services to a growing list of
customers. BAX Global's supply chain management business specializes in
developing solutions that include the design, implementation and management of
inventory, distribution and information processes to improve a customer's
efficiency and productivity.
BAX Global operates value-added logistics warehouse and distribution facilities
in key world markets. Companies in the healthcare, retail, automotive, aerospace
and high technology industries have been targeted as businesses with significant
supply chain management needs.
AIRCRAFT OPERATIONS
BAX Global has a fleet of leased and contracted aircraft providing regularly
scheduled next-day service throughout North America. BAX Global's wholly owned
subsidiary, ATI, is a U.S.-based freight and passenger airline that operates a
certificated fleet of DC-8 aircraft. BAX Global operates Boeing 727s under
contracts that provide the aircraft, crew, maintenance and insurance ("ACMI").
ATI also provides domestic and international service for the U.S. Government Air
Mobility Command and other charter customers.
The following is a summary of BAX Global's fleet as of December 31, 2002.
BAX Global's
Transportation Charter
Network Customers Grounded Total
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------
DC-8:
Cargo:
Leased 10 3 - 13
Owned - - 4 4
Combi-Configured (a):
Leased - 3 - 3
Owned - 2 - 2
727-CARGO-ACMI 10 - - 10
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------
Total Planes 20 8 4 32
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------
(a) Aircraft configured to accommodate both passengers and cargo.
Of the 20 planes in BAX Global's transportation network, 17 are assigned to
regularly scheduled routes. Generally, three planes are held for use as backups
or are in maintenance.
BAX Global's nightly scheduled lift capacity for planes in operation at December
31, 2002 was approximately 1.0 million pounds, based on an average freight
density of 7.5 pounds per cubic foot. BAX Global's nightly lift capacity varies
depending upon the number and type of planes operated by BAX Global at any
particular time. Including trucking capacity available to BAX Global, the
aggregate daily cargo capacity at December 31, 2002, was approximately 1.9
million pounds.
For aircraft held under long-term lease, BAX Global is generally responsible for
all the normal costs of operating and maintaining the aircraft. In addition, BAX
Global is generally responsible for all or a portion of any special maintenance
or modifications which may be required by Federal Aviation Administration
("FAA") regulations or orders (see "Government Regulation" below). BAX Global's
ultimate liability for FAA matters is generally subject to dollar limits,
specific exclusions and sharing arrangements with
-5-
<PAGE>
the lessors. Over the last three years, BAX Global spent approximately $97
million on routine heavy maintenance of its aircraft fleet. BAX Global is
generally responsible for fuel costs and other incidental costs such as landing
fees for aircraft operated under ACMI contracts.
See Notes 14 and 21 to the Consolidated Financial Statements in the Company's
2002 Annual Report for information regarding future minimum lease payments and
other purchase commitments related to the Company's aircraft. BAX Global's 16
leased aircraft have various expiration dates extending through 2005, and its 10
planes under ACMI contracts have various expiration dates through 2004. Based on
the current state of the aircraft leasing market, BAX Global believes that it
should be able to renew these leases or enter into new leases on terms
reasonably comparable to those currently in effect.
The average airframe age of the fleet operated by ATI is in excess of 30 years;
however, the condition of a particular aircraft and its fair market value is
dependent on its maintenance history. Factors other than age, such as cycles
(essentially the number of flights) can have a significant impact on an
aircraft's serviceability. Generally, cargo aircraft tend to have fewer cycles
than passenger aircraft over comparable time periods because they are used for
fewer flights per day and longer flight segments.
Fuel costs are a significant element of the total costs of operating BAX
Global's aircraft fleet. Fuel prices are subject to worldwide and local market
conditions. In order to protect against price increases in jet fuel, from time
to time BAX Global enters into hedging agreements, including swap contracts,
options and collars. BAX Global charges a fuel surcharge in the U.S. to its
customers when fuel costs are higher.
CUSTOMERS
BAX Global's customers include thousands of large and small industrial and
commercial businesses. Worldwide, BAX Global's top 10 customers accounted for
less than 16% of total BAX Global revenue in 2002. The Company targets customers
in the automotive, aerospace, healthcare, high technology, retail and other
industries where rapid delivery of high-value products is required.
COMPETITION
The transportation and supply chain management industries have been and are
expected to remain highly competitive. The principal competitive factors in the
transportation industry are price, the ability to provide consistently fast and
reliable delivery of shipments and the ability to provide premium services such
as shipment tracking. The principal competitive factors in the supply chain
industry are price, access to a reliable transportation network, warehousing and
distribution capabilities, and sophisticated information systems.
There is aggressive price competition in the heavy-freight market, particularly
for the business of high volume shippers. BAX Global competes with various types
of transportation companies, including other integrated transportation companies
that operate their own fleets, as well as with freight forwarders, premium
less-than-truckload (or "LTL") carriers, express delivery services, and
passenger airlines.
Domestically, BAX Global also competes with package delivery services provided
by ground transportation companies, including trucking firms and surface freight
forwarders that offer specialized time-specific services within limited
geographical areas. As an international freight forwarder, BAX Global competes
with government-owned or subsidized passenger airlines, postal services and
ocean shipping companies.
BAX Global believes its hub-and-spoke network of aircraft and trucks that serves
the North American market allows it to move freight more reliably than if it
solely used third-party services. The hub, which is located in Toledo, Ohio,
consists of various facilities, including a technologically advanced material
handling system, which is capable of sorting approximately one million pounds of
freight per hour. BAX Global believes its hub-and-spoke system feeds much of its
North American import and export business and believes it provides a competitive
advantage by offering superior, reliable service to its customers, shipping to,
from or within North America.
In supply chain management services, BAX Global competes with many third-party
logistics providers.
EMPLOYEE RELATIONS
BAX Global and its subsidiaries have approximately 10,000 employees worldwide,
of whom about 1,200 are classified as part-time.
As of December 31, 2002, approximately 200 flight crewmembers (captains, first
officers and flight engineers), were represented for purposes of collective
bargaining by the International Brotherhood of Teamsters. Another 100 employees
in the U.S. (principally customer service, clerical and/or dock workers) were
represented by labor unions that in most cases are also affiliated with the
International Brotherhood of Teamsters. BAX Global did not experience any
significant strike or work stoppage in 2002 and believes that its employee
relations are satisfactory.
GOVERNMENT REGULATION
The air transportation industry, including BAX Global, is subject to regulation
by the FAA under the Federal Aviation Act of 1958, as amended, and the
Transportation Security Administration ("TSA") under the Aviation and
Transportation Security Act of 2001. The FAA and TSA are agencies of the
Department of Transportation ("DOT").
BAX Global is subject to various other requirements and regulations in
connection with its operations, including certain safety and security
regulations of the DOT and other federal and state agencies. BAX Global's
international operations are regulated by varying degrees by the countries in
which they operate.
-6-
<PAGE>
PROPERTIES
BAX Global has approximately 260 company-operated stations (100 domestic and 160
international) and has agency agreements with approximately 240 stations (50
domestic and 190 international). BAX Global's stations are usually located at or
near airports or other transportation corridors. BAX Global operates domestic
stations, which generally include office space and warehousing facilities
located in 39 states, the District of Columbia and Puerto Rico. BAX Global
operates international facilities in 30 countries. Nearly all company-operated
stations are leased.
BAX Global operates its main distribution facility at Toledo Express Airport in
Ohio, which facilitates a fleet of aircraft and a freight-sorting operation and
related facilities (the "Hub"). The BAX Global Hub has a lease expiring in 2013
with the Toledo-Lucas County Port Authority. The lease provides BAX Global with
rights of renewal for three five-year periods. Other facilities in the U.S. are
held under leases having terms of one to ten years.
BAX Global provides certain transportation customers with supply chain
management services and operates more than 40 leased logistics warehouse and
distribution facilities in key world markets.
During 2002, BAX Global leased a new 116,000 square foot corporate office
facility through 2012 located in Irvine, California.
See "Aircraft Operations" above for information about contracted, leased and
owned aircraft.
OTHER OPERATIONS
The Company's Other Operations include its gold, timber and natural gas
businesses. At the end of 2002, the Company's Other Operations had approximately
60 employees. The Company does not consider its businesses within its Other
Operations to be core businesses. The Company expects to exit these activities
to focus resources on its core Business and Security Services segments.
Each of the gold, timber and natural gas businesses operate in cyclical
commodity business environments where prices are determined based partly on the
local and worldwide economy. The results of operations of each of these
businesses are highly dependent on the price of their respective products.
The Company's Other Operations own properties and interests including land,
hardwood forests, natural gas reserves and a gold mine and reserves.
GOLD
The Company's gold business is directed at locating and acquiring mineral
assets, developing advanced stage projects and operating mines.
At December 31, 2002, the Company had a 45.1% interest in MPI Mines Ltd. ("MPI")
and through its ownership of MPI and a 50% direct interest, the Company had a
72.5% interest in a gold mine in Stawell, Victoria, Australia ("Stawell"). At
December 31, 2002, through its ownership of MPI and a 25% direct interest, the
Company had a 36.3% interest in a gold mine and gold mill tolling operation in
Coolgardie, Western Australia.
In the fourth quarter 2002, the Company entered into an agreement to negotiate
the transfer of its direct interests in its Stawell and Coolgardie gold mining
joint ventures to MPI in exchange for additional shares of MPI and royalties on
future production. The transfer is contingent upon various factors.
In January 2003, MPI registered its shares on the Australian Stock Exchange and
issued additional shares of stock. After the new shares were issued, the Company
owns 30.4% of MPI.
Stawell's and Coolgardie's 2002 production and estimates of proved and probable
gold reserves as of December 31, 2002 were as follows:
2002
(Ounces of gold) Production Reserves
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Stawell 101,000 222,000
Coolgardie 3,000 181,000
TIMBER
The Company's timber business has a sawmill facility that produces products
primarily for the hardwood flooring industry. The timber business also sells
hardwood chips to the paper industry and logs to other sawmill customers that
are used in the high-grade furniture and veneer markets. The Company owns
approximately 140 thousand acres of surface and timberlands in southwest
Virginia.
NATURAL GAS
The Company invests in and receives royalty income from gas development and
operations. Net proved developed natural gas reserves located in Virginia and
West Virginia approximated 57 billion cubic feet including royalty interests and
a small interest purchased in the first quarter of 2003.
FORMER OPERATIONS
During December 2002, the Company concluded its plan to sell or shut down its
remaining coal mining operations and is no longer operating as an active coal
producer.
The Company intends to continue to market its residual coal assets to interested
parties. The Company has retained certain coal-related liabilities and related
expenses. Retained liabilities include obligations related to postretirement
benefits for Company-sponsored plans, black lung benefits, reclamation and other
costs related to idle (shut-down) mines which have been retained, Health Benefit
Act, workers' compensation claims and costs of withdrawal from multi-employer
pension plans. Expenses related to these liabilities have been reflected in the
loss from discontinued operations through the disposal date. Subsequent to
-7-
<PAGE>
the completion of the disposal process (for the period beginning
January 1, 2003), adjustments to coal-related contingent liabilities will be
reflected in discontinued operations, and expenses related to Company-sponsored
pension and postretirement benefit obligations and black lung obligations will
be reflected in continuing operations. In addition, subsequent to the disposal
date, the Company expects to have certain ongoing costs related to the
administration of the retained liabilities and will report those costs in
continuing operations. A portion of the obligations are expected to be assumed
by parties that purchase the Company's residual coal assets. The Company has not
recorded these obligations as liabilities on the balance sheet. The obligations
could be recorded as liabilities on the balance sheet in the future (with an
additional charge to earnings) if the Company no longer believes these
obligations will be assumed by other parties. See Notes 5 and 21 to the
Consolidated Financial Statements, which Notes are herein incorporated by
reference.
At December 31, 2002, the Company had approximately 110 employees related to its
former coal operations. These employees perform various duties including
reclaiming and maintaining residual assets and managing other retained
liabilities related to the former coal operations.
ENVIRONMENTAL MATTERS
The Surface Mining Control and Reclamation Act of 1977 and the regulations
promulgated thereunder ("SMCRA") by the Federal Office of Surface Mining
Reclamation and Enforcement ("OSM") establish mining and reclamation standards
for all aspects of surface mining as well as many aspects of deep mining. OSM
and its state counterparts monitor compliance with SMCRA. The Company's policy
is to correct violations that are the subject of OSM notices or to contest those
believed to be without merit.
The Company is also subject to other federal environmental laws, including the
Resource Conservation and Recovery Act; the Occupational Safety and Health Act;
the Toxic Substances Control Act; the Comprehensive Environmental Resource,
Compensation and Liability Act; the Clean Water Act; the Clean Air Act and the
Safe Drinking Water Act, as well as state laws of similar scope. The Company
believes it is in compliance with all applicable environmental laws.
The Company has agreed to pay 80% of the remediation costs arising from
hydrocarbon contamination at a formerly owned petroleum terminal facility
("Tankport") in Jersey City, New Jersey, which was sold in 1983. The Company is
in the process of remediating the site under an approved plan. The Company
estimates its portion of the actual remaining clean-up and operational and
maintenance costs, on an undiscounted basis, to be between $2.2 million and $4.3
million. The Company is in discussions with another potentially responsible
party to recover a portion of the amount paid and to be paid by the Company
related to this matter.
HEALTH AND SAFETY LAWS
Health and safety standards in the U.S. coal industry, including reclamation and
maintenance activities on the Company's residual coal assets, are legislated by
the Federal Coal Mine Health and Safety Act of 1969 and the Federal Mine Safety
and Health Act of 1977. The Company believes it is in compliance with all
applicable health and safety laws.
PROPERTIES
The residual properties of the Company's former coal operations are (i) unmined
or partially mined coal reserves, (ii) closed or idled coal mines, (iii) an
idled coal preparation plant, (iv) a corporate office in Lebanon, VA, and (v)
various other properties. The Company is attempting to sell coal reserves it
owns or leases primarily in West Virginia. Leases of land or coal mining rights
generally are either for a long-term period or until exhaustion of the reserves.
FORWARD-LOOKING INFORMATION
Certain of the matters discussed herein, including statements regarding
significant ongoing expenses and cash outflows related to former coal operations
in the future (including costs related to the administration of retained
liabilities), the uninterrupted supply of equipment to BHS, the impact that the
refusal of police departments to respond to calls from alarm companies without
visual verification would have on BHS' results of operations, the expected
seasonal impact on the volumes shipped by BAX Global, the ability of BAX Global
to renew certain aircraft leases or enter into new leases on reasonably
comparable terms, the highly competitive nature of the transportation and supply
chain management industries, the Company's plan to exit its gold, timber and
natural gas businesses, the consummation of the transfer of the Company's direct
interests in the Stawell and Coolgardie joint ventures to MPI, the amount of
proved and probable gold reserves, the amount of proved developed atural gas
reserves, the ability to sell residual coal assets and transfer various related
obligations, the possibility that various obligations associated with the
Company's former coal business may be recorded as liabilities on the balance
sheet in the future (with an additional charge to earnings), estimates of
clean-up, operational and maintenance costs relating to the Tankport matter and
possibility that the Company will be able to recover a portion of amounts paid
or to be paid from another potentially responsible party, involve
forward-looking information which is subject to known and unknown risks,
uncertainties, and contingencies which could cause actual results, performance
or achievements, to differ materially from those which are
anticipated.
Such risks, uncertainties and contingencies, many of which are beyond the
control of the Company, include, but are not limited to, actual retirement
experience of the former coal operation's employees, black lung claims
incidence, the number of dependents covered under benefit obligations, coal
industry turnover rates, actual medical and legal costs relating to the
benefits, changes in inflation rates (including the continued volatility of
medical
-8-
<PAGE>
inflation), the performance of BHS' equipment suppliers, the incidence
of false alarms, the willingness of BHS' customers to pay for private response
personnel or other alternatives to police responses to alarms, the market for
airplanes, the ability to obtain appropriate value for the gold, timber, and
natural gas businesses and the remaining coal assets. The negotiation of
definitive agreements for such businesses and assets, as well as for the Stawell
and Coolgardie joint ventures, and the satisfaction of any conditions to closing
contained therein, including the receipt of various consents and other
approvals, changes in the Company's strategies regarding the sale of gold,
timber and natural gas businesses, the actual amount of gold reserves and
natural gas reserves held by the Company's Other Operations, the accuracy of the
testing done and the validity of the assumptions used in estimating gold and
natural gas reserves,the completion and processing of permit replacement
documentation and the ability of purchasers of coal assets to post the required
bonds, changes in the Company's belief that various obligations associated with
the former coal business will be assumed by other parties, changes in the scope
or method of remediation or monitoring of the Tankport property, the negotiation
of a mutually acceptable agreement with the potentially responsible party in the
Tankport matter, overall economic and business conditions, foreign currency
exchange rates, the demand for the Company's products and services, the ability
of the Company and its operations to obtain appropriate insurance coverage at
reasonable prices, pricing and other competitive industry factors, fuel prices,
new government regulations and legislative initiatives, issuance of permits,
judicial decisions, variations in costs or expenses including interest rates,
and the ability of counterparties to perform.
-9-
<PAGE>
ITEM 3. LEGAL PROCEEDINGS
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Not applicable.
ITEM 4. SUBMISSION OF MATTER TO A VOTE OF SECURITY HOLDERS
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Not applicable.
-10-
<PAGE>
EXECUTIVE OFFICERS OF THE REGISTRANT
The following is a list as of March 15, 2003, of the names and ages of the
executive and other officers of Pittston and the names and ages of certain
officers of its subsidiaries, indicating the principal positions and offices
held by each. There is no family relationship between any of the officers named.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
Name Age Positions and Offices Held Held Since
- ----------------------------- -------- --- ---------------------------------------------------------------- --------------------
EXECUTIVE OFFICERS:
<S> <C> <C> <C>
Michael T. Dan 52 President, Chief Executive Officer and Chairman of the Board 1998
James B. Hartough 55 Vice President-Corporate Finance and Treasurer 1988
Frank T. Lennon 61 Vice President-Human Resources and Administration 1985
Austin F. Reed 51 Vice President, General Counsel and Secretary 1994
Robert T. Ritter 51 Vice President and Chief Financial Officer 1998
OTHER OFFICERS:
Matthew A.P. Schumacher 44 Controller 2001
Arthur E. Wheatley 60 Vice President and Director-Risk Management 1988
SUBSIDIARY OFFICERS:
Joseph L. Carnes 45 President of BAX Global Inc. 2000
Robert B. Allen 49 President of Brink's Home Security, Inc. 2001
- ----------------------------- -------- --- ---------------------------------------------------------------- --------------------
</TABLE>
Executive and other officers of Pittston are elected annually and serve at the
pleasure of its Board of Directors.
Mr. Dan was elected President, Chief Executive Officer and Director of The
Pittston Company on February 6, 1998 and was elected Chairman of the Board
effective January 1, 1999. He also serves as Chief Executive Officer of Brink's,
Incorporated, a position he has held since July 1993 and as President and Chief
Executive Officer of Brink's Holding Company, a position he has held since
December 31, 1995. He assumed the position of President of Brink's, Incorporated
in December 2002. He also serves as Chairman of the Board of BAX Global Inc., a
position he has held since February 1998. He also serves as Chairman of the
Board of Pittston Mineral Ventures, a position he has held since August 31, 1998
and as Chairman of the Board of Pittston Coal Company, a position he has held
since September 1, 1998. From August 1992 to July 1993 he served as President of
North American operations of Brink's, Incorporated and as Executive Vice
President of Brink's, Incorporated from 1985 to 1992.
Mr. Ritter joined The Pittston Company as Vice President and Chief Financial
Officer in August 1998. From June 1996 to July 1998, he served as Chief
Financial Officer of WLR Foods, Inc. He was a private investor and financial
consultant from April 1995 to May 1996 and was Treasurer at American Cyanamid
Company from March 1991 to January 1994 and Controller from February 1994 to
March 1995.
Messrs. Hartough, Lennon, Reed and Wheatley have served in their present
positions for more than the past five years.
Mr. Schumacher was elected to his current position on July 13, 2001 after
joining the Company in July 2001. For the five years prior to July 2001, he was
employed by NL Industries, Inc. as the Manager of Financial Reporting in 1996
and as the Assistant Controller in 1997 through July 2001.
Mr. Carnes was elected President of BAX Global Inc. in May 2000. He joined BAX
Global Inc. as President - U.S. and Canada in September 1999. Prior to joining
BAX Global Inc., he served as Executive Vice President, North America for Fritz
Companies Inc. where he was employed from 1987 to 1999.
Mr. Allen joined Brink's Home Security, Inc. in August 1999 as Executive Vice
President and Chief Operating Officer. He was promoted to President of Brink's
Home Security, Inc. in March 2001. From January 1997 to August 1999, he held
various positions at Aegis Communications Group (formerly ATC Communications)
including Executive Vice President of Sales and Marketing and Chief Operating
Officer. From 1980 through 1996, he held various domestic and international
positions at Frito-Lay including Vice President of Field Marketing and Country
Manager in Greece and Turkey.
-11-
<PAGE>
PART II
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
ITEM 5. MARKET FOR REGISTRANT'S COMMON EQUITY AND RELATED SHAREHOLDER MATTERS
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Prior to January 14, 2000, the Company had three classes of common stock:
Pittston Brink's Group Common Stock ("Brink's Stock"), Pittston BAX Group Common
Stock ("BAX Stock") and Pittston Minerals Group Common Stock ("Minerals Stock").
On January 14, 2000, the holders of Minerals Stock received 0.0817 shares of
Brink's Stock for each share of their Minerals Stock, and holders of BAX Stock
received 0.4848 shares of Brink's Stock for each share of their BAX Stock.
Brink's Stock is now the only outstanding class of common stock of the Company
and continues to trade on the New York Stock Exchange under the symbol "PZB."
Reference is made to page 77 of the Company's 2002 Annual Report which is herein
incorporated by reference, for other information required by this item.
ITEM 6. SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Reference is made to pages 78 and 79 of the Company's 2002 Annual Report which
is herein incorporated by reference, for information required by this item.
ITEM 7. MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF RESULTS OF OPERATIONS AND
FINANCIAL CONDITION
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Reference is made to pages 2 through 36 of the Company's 2002 Annual Report
which is herein incorporated by reference, for information required by this
item.
ITEM 7A. QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
The information regarding quantitative and qualitative disclosures about market
risk is included in this report under Item 7.
ITEM 8. FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTARY DATA
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Reference is made to pages 37 through 77 of the Company's 2002 Annual Report
which is herein incorporated by reference, for information required by this
item.
ITEM 9. CHANGES IN AND DISAGREEMENTS WITH ACCOUNTANTS ON ACCOUNTING AND
FINANCIAL DISCLOSURE
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Not applicable.
-12-
<PAGE>
PART III
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
ITEM 10. DIRECTORS AND EXECUTIVE OFFICERS OF THE REGISTRANT
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
The information required by this Item regarding directors is herein incorporated
by reference to the Company's definitive proxy statement to be filed pursuant to
Regulation 14A within 120 days after December 31, 2002. The information
regarding executive officers is included in this report following Item 4, under
the caption "Executive Officers of the Registrant."
ITEM 11. EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
The information required by Item 11 is incorporated by reference to the
Company's definitive proxy statement to be filed pursuant to Regulation 14A
within 120 days after December 31, 2002.
ITEM 12. SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
Equity Compensation Plan Information
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of securities remaining
Plan Category Number of securities to be issued Weighted average excercise available for future issuance under
upon exercise of outstanding price of outstanding options, equity compensation plans (excluding
(Shares in millions) options warrants and rights warrants and rights securities reflected in column (a))
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(a) (b) (c)(1)
<S> <C> <C> <C>
Equity compensation
plans approved by
security holders 4,123,973 $ 23.18 1,591,479
Equity compensation
plans not approved
by security holders - - -
- -----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Total 4,123,973 $ 23.18 1,591,479
- -----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<FN>
(1)The Key Employees' Deferred Compensation Program of The Pittston Company, as
approved by shareholders, has no limit as to the number of securities available
for issuance. The Pittston Company Director's Stock Accumulation Plan, as
approved by shareholders, has 17,006 shares available for issuance.
</FN>
</TABLE>
Other information required by Item 12 is incorporated by reference to the
Company's definitive proxy statement to be filed pursuant to Regulation 14A
within 120 days after December 31, 2002.
ITEM 13. CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
The information required by Item 13 is incorporated by reference to the
Company's definitive proxy statement to be filed pursuant to Regulation 14A
within 120 days after December 31, 2002.
ITEM 14. CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Within the 90 days prior to the filing date of this report, the Company
performed an evaluation under the supervision and with the participation of the
Company's management, including the Chief Executive Officer and the Chief
Financial Officer, of the effectiveness of the design and operation of the
Company's disclosure controls and procedures. Based on that evaluation, the
Company's management, including the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial
Officer, concluded that the Company's disclosure controls and procedures were
effective in ensuring that material information relating to the Company was made
known to them, particularly with respect to the period covered by this report.
There have been no significant changes in the Company's internal controls or in
other factors that could significantly affect internal controls subsequent to
date of the evaluation.
-13-
<PAGE>
PART IV
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
ITEM 15. EXHIBITS, FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES AND REPORTS ON FORM 8-K
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(a) 1. All financial statements - see index to financial statements and
schedules.
2. Financial statement schedules - see index to financial statements and
schedules.
3. Exhibits - see exhibit index.
(b) A report on Form 8-K was filed on December 30, 2002. Under Items 2 and
7 the Company reported the sale of its coal operations in Virginia to
subsidiaries of Alpha Natural Resources, LLC and provided the required
pro forma financial information. No other reports on Form 8-K were
filed during the fourth quarter of 2002 and through the date of this
report.
UNDERTAKING
For the purposes of complying with the amendments to the rules governing Form
S-8 (effective July 13, 1990) under the Securities Act of 1933, the undersigned
Registrant hereby undertakes as follows, which undertaking shall be incorporated
by reference into Registrant's Registration Statements on Form S-8 Nos. 2-64258,
33-2039, 33-21393, 33-23333, 33-69040, 33-53565, 333-02219, 333-78631,
333-78633, 333-70758, 333-70772, 333-70766 and 333-70762. Insofar as
indemnification for liabilities arising under the Securities Act of 1933 may be
permitted to directors, officers and controlling persons of the Registrant
pursuant to the foregoing provisions, or otherwise, the Registrant has been
advised that in the opinion of the Securities and Exchange Commission such
indemnification is against public policy as expressed in the Securities Act of
1933 and is, therefore, unenforceable. In the event that a claim for
indemnification against liabilities (other than the payment by the Registrant of
expenses incurred or paid by a director, officer or controlling person of the
Registrant in the successful defense of any action, suit or proceeding) is
asserted by such director, officer or controlling person in connection with the
securities being registered, the Registrant will, unless in the opinion of its
counsel the matter has been settled by controlling precedent, submit to a court
of appropriate jurisdiction the question whether such indemnification by it is
against public policy as expressed in the Act and will be governed by the final
adjudication of such issue.
-14-
<PAGE>
SIGNATURES
Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange
Act of 1934, the Registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its
behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, on March 26, 2003.
The Pittston Company
-----------------------------
(Registrant)
By /s/ M. T. Dan
-----------------------------------
(M. T. Dan,
Chairman, President and
Chief Executive Officer)
Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report
has been signed below by the following persons on behalf of the Registrant and
in the capacities indicated, on March 26, 2003.
Signatures Title
----------------- -----------
R. G. Ackerman* Director
B. C. Alewine* Director
J. R. Barker* Director
M. C. Breslawsky* Director
J. L. Broadhead* Director
W. F. Craig* Director
/s/ M. T. Dan
------------------------------------------
(M. T. Dan) Chairman, President and
Chief Executive Officer
(principal executive officer)
M.L. Grimes* Director
G. Grinstein* Director
R. M. Gross* Director
/s/ R. T. Ritter
----------------------------------------------
(R. T. Ritter) Vice President and
and Chief Financial Officer
(principal financial officer and
principal accounting officer)
C. S. Sloane* Director
R. L. Turner* Director
*By /s/ M. T. Dan
-------------------------------------
(M. T. Dan, Attorney-in-Fact)
-15-
<PAGE>
CERTIFICATIONS
I, Michael T. Dan, certify that:
1. I have reviewed this annual report on Form 10-K of The
Pittston Company;
2. Based on my knowledge, this annual report does not contain any
untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a
material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light
of the circumstances under which such statements were made,
not misleading with respect to the period covered by this
annual report;
3. Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other
financial information included in this annual report, fairly
present in all material respects the financial condition,
results of operations and cash flows of the registrant as of,
and for, the periods presented in this annual report;
4. The registrant's other certifying officer and I are
responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure
controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules
13a-14 and 15d-14) for the registrant and have:
a) Designed such disclosure controls and procedures to
ensure that material information relating to the
registrant, including its consolidated subsidiaries,
is made known to us by others within those entities,
particularly during the period in which this annual
report is being prepared;
b) Evaluated the effectiveness of the registrant's
disclosure controls and procedures as of a date
within 90 days prior to the filing date of this
annual report (the "Evaluation Date"); and
c) Presented in this annual report our conclusions about
the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and
procedures based on our evaluation as of the
Evaluation Date;
5. The registrant's other certifying officer and I have
disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation, to the
registrant's auditors and the audit committee of registrant's
board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent
functions):
a) All significant deficiencies in the design or
operation of internal controls which could adversely
affect the registrant's ability to record, process,
summarize and report financial data and have
identified for the registrant's auditors any material
weaknesses in internal controls; and
b) Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves
management or other employees who have a significant
role in the registrant's internal controls; and
6. The registrant's other certifying officer and I have indicated
in this annual report whether there were significant changes
in internal controls or in other factors that could
significantly affect internal controls subsequent to the date
of our most recent evaluation, including any corrective
actions with regard to significant deficiencies and material
weaknesses.
Date: March 26, 2003 /s/ Michael T. Dan
---------------------------
Michael T. Dan
Chief Executive Officer
-16-
<PAGE>
CERTIFICATIONS (CONTINUED)
I, Robert T. Ritter, certify that:
1. I have reviewed this annual report on Form 10-K of The
Pittston Company;
2. Based on my knowledge, this annual report does not contain any
untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a
material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light
of the circumstances under which such statements were made,
not misleading with respect to the period covered by this
annual report;
3. Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other
financial information included in this annual report, fairly
present in all material respects the financial condition,
results of operations and cash flows of the registrant as of,
and for, the periods presented in this annual report;
4. The registrant's other certifying officer and I are
responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure
controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules
13a-14 and 15d-14) for the registrant and have:
a) Designed such disclosure controls and procedures to
ensure that material information relating to the
registrant, including its consolidated subsidiaries,
is made known to us by others within those entities,
particularly during the period in which this annual
report is being prepared;
b) Evaluated the effectiveness of the registrant's
disclosure controls and procedures as of a date
within 90 days prior to the filing date of this
annual report (the "Evaluation Date"); and
c) Presented in this annual report our conclusions about
the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and
procedures based on our evaluation as of the
Evaluation Date;
5. The registrant's other certifying officer and I have
disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation, to the
registrant's auditors and the audit committee of registrant's
board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent
functions):
a) All significant deficiencies in the design or
operation of internal controls which could adversely
affect the registrant's ability to record, process,
summarize and report financial data and have
identified for the registrant's auditors any material
weaknesses in internal controls; and
b) Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves
management or other employees who have a significant
role in the registrant's internal controls; and
6. The registrant's other certifying officer and I have indicated
in this annual report whether there were significant changes
in internal controls or in other factors that could
significantly affect internal controls subsequent to the date
of our most recent evaluation, including any corrective
actions with regard to significant deficiencies and material
weaknesses.
Date: March 26, 2003 /s/ Robert T. Ritter
-----------------------------------
Robert T. Ritter
Vice President and Chief Financial Officer
-17-
<PAGE>
INDEX TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SCHEDULES
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS:
The Consolidated Financial Statements of The Pittston Company, listed in the
index below which are included in the Company's 2002 Annual Report for the year
ended December 31, 2002, are herein incorporated by reference. With the
exception of the pages listed in the index below and the information
incorporated by reference included in Parts I, II and IV, the 2002 Annual Report
of the Shareholders is not deemed filed as part of this report.
THE PITTSTON COMPANY ANNUAL REPORT
Page Numbers in
2002 Annual Report
--------------------
Management's Discussion and Analysis of
Results of Operations and Financial Condition......2-36
Independent Auditors' Report............................38
Consolidated Balance Sheets.............................39
Consolidated Statements of Operations................40-41
Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Loss...........42
Consolidated Statements of Shareholders' Equity.........43
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows...................44
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements...........45-77
Selected Financial Data .............................78-79
FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES:
Page Numbers
in Form 10-K
--------------
Independent Auditors' Report
on Financial Statement Schedule......................19
Schedule II - Valuation and qualifying accounts.........20
-18-
<PAGE>
INDEPENDENT AUDITORS' REPORT ON FINANCIAL STATEMENT
SCHEDULE
The Board of Directors
The Pittston Company
Under date of February 10, 2003, we reported on the consolidated balance sheets
of The Pittston Company and subsidiaries (the "Company") as of December 31, 2002
and 2001, and the related consolidated statements of operations, comprehensive
loss, shareholders' equity and cash flows for each of the years in the
three-year period ended December 31, 2002, as contained in the 2002 annual
report on Form 10-K. In connection with our audits of the aforementioned
consolidated financial statements, we also audited the related financial
statement schedule as included herein. This financial statement schedule is the
responsibility of the Company's management. Our responsibility is to express an
opinion on this financial statement schedule based on our audits.
In our opinion, such financial statement schedule, when considered in relation
to the basic consolidated financial statements taken as a whole, presents
fairly, in all material aspects, the information set forth therein.
As discussed in Note 1 to the consolidated financial statements, effective
January 1, 2002, the Company adopted the provisions of Statement of Financial
Accounting Standards No. 142, "Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets." Also as
discussed in Note 1 to the consolidated financial statements, the Company
changed its method of accounting for nonrefundable installation revenues and the
related direct costs of acquiring new subscribers in 2000 as a result of the
implementation of Staff Accounting Bulletin No. 101, "Revenue Recognition in
Financial Statements."
/s/ KPMG LLP
Richmond, Virginia
February 10, 2003
-19-
<PAGE>
The Pittston Company
Schedule II - Valuation and Qualifying Accounts
For the Years Ending December 31, 2002, 2001 and 2000
(in millions)
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
Balance at Charged to Currency Balance at
Beginning of Costs and Translation End of
Period Expenses (a) Deductions (b) Adjustment Period
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Allowance for Doubtful Accounts
<S> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C>
Year Ended December 31, 2000 $ 36.2 22.8 (17.8) (1.4) 39.8
Year Ended December 31, 2001 39.8 12.3 (8.9) (1.4) 41.8
Year Ended December 31, 2002 41.8 4.6 (11.8) 0.9 35.5
Valuation Allowance
Year Ended December 31, 2000 7.2 1.8 - - 9.0
Year Ended December 31, 2001 9.0 1.3 - - 10.3
Year Ended December 31, 2002 $ 10.3 1.5 - (2.0) 9.8
<FN>
(a) Includes amounts charged to loss from discontinued operations.
(b) Amounts written off, less recoveries
</FN>
</TABLE>
-20-
<PAGE>
EXHIBIT INDEX
Each Exhibit listed previously filed document is hereby incorporated by
reference to such document.
EXHIBIT
NUMBER DESCRIPTION
2(i) Membership Interest Acquisition Agreement
Among Air Transport International LLC and BAX
Global Inc., dated February 3, 1998. Exhibit
2 to the Registrant's Current Report on Form
8-K filed May 14, 1998.
2(ii) Share Purchase Agreement, dated as of January 27, 1998, between
Brink's Security International, Inc., acting as Purchaser, and
Generale de Transport et D'Industrie, acting as Seller. Exhibit 10(v)
to the Registrant's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended
December 31, 1998 (the "1998 Form 10-K").
2(iii) Shareholders' Agreement, dated as of January
10, 1997, between Brink's Security
International, Inc., and Valores Tamanaco,
C.A. Exhibit 10(w) to the 1998 Form 10-K.
3(i) The Registrant's Articles of Correction to
its Articles of Incorporation. Exhibit 3(i)
to the Registrant's Quarterly Report on Form
10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 1998.
3(ii) The Registrant's Bylaws, as amended through September 12, 2003.
Exhibit 3(b) to the Registrant's Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the
quarter ended September 30, 2002 (the "Third Quarter 2002 Form 10-Q").
4(a) (i) Amended and Restated Rights
Agreement dated as of January 14,
2000 (the "Rights Agreement"),
between the Registrant and Bank
Boston, N.A., as Rights Agent.
Exhibit 4(a) (i) to the
Registrant's Annual Report on
Form 10-K for the year ended
December 31, 2000 (the "2000 Form
10-K").
(ii) Form of Right Certificate for
Rights. Exhibit 4(a)(ii) to the
2000 Form 10-K. Instruments
defining the rights of holders of
long-term debt of the Registrant
and its consolidated subsidiaries
have been omitted because the
amount of debt under any such
instrument does not exceed 10% of
the total assets of the
Registrant and its consolidated
subsidiaries. The Registrant
agrees to furnish a copy of any
such instrument to the Commission
upon request. Exhibit 4(a) to the
Registrant's Annual Report on
Form 10-K for the year ended
December 31, 1999 (the "1999 Form
10-K").
(iii) Amendment, effective November 30,
2001, by and among The Pittston
Company, Fleet National Bank (f/k/a
BankBoston, N.A.) and EquiServe
Trust Company, N.A., to the Amended
and Restated Rights Agreement dated
as of January 14, 2000 between The
Pittston Company and BankBoston,
N.A., as Rights Agent. Exhibit 1 to
the Registrant's Amendment No. 3 to
Form 8-A/A (filed on January 14,
2002).
10(a)* The Key Employees' Incentive Plan, as
amended. Exhibit 10(a) to the 1998 Form
10-K.
10(b)* The Key Employees' Deferred Compensation Program, as amended and
restated as of January 14, 2000. Exhibit 10(b) to the 1999 Form
10-K.
10(c)* (i) The Registrant's Pension Equalization Plan as amended.
Exhibit 10(e)(I) to the Registrant's Annual Report on Form
10-K for the year ended December 31, 1997 (the "1997 Form
10-K").
(ii) Amended and Restated Trust Agreement, dated December 1,
1997, between the Registrant and Chase Manhattan Bank, as
Trustee (the "Trust Agreement"). Exhibit 10(e)(ii) to the
1997 Form 10-K.
(iii) Amendment No. 1 to Trust Agreement,
dated as of August 18, 1999. Exhibit 10(c)(iii) to the
1999 Form 10-K.
(iv) Amendment No. 2 to Trust Agreement,
-21-
<PAGE>
dated as of July 26, 2001.
(v) Amendment No. 3 to Trust Agreement,
dated as of September 18, 2002.
(vi) Trust Agreement under the Pension
Equalization Plan, Retirement Plan
for Non-Employee Directors and
Certain Contractual Arrangements of
The Pittston Company made as of
September 16, 1994, by and between
the Registrant and Chase Manhattan
Bank (National Association), as
Trustee. Exhibit 10(i) to the
Registrant's Quarterly Report on
Form 10-Q for the quarter ended
September 30, 1994 (filed November
14, 1994 - File No. 1-9148) (the
"Third Quarter 1994 Form 10-Q").
(vii) Form of letter agreement dated as of September 16, 1994,
between the Registrant and one of its officers. Exhibit
10(e) to the Third Quarter 1994 Form 10-Q.
(viii) Form of letter agreement dated as of September 16, 1994,
between the Registrant and Participants pursuant to the
Pension Equalization Plan. Exhibit 10(f) to the Third
Quarter 1994 Form 10-Q.
10(d)* The Registrant's Executive Salary
Continuation Plan. Exhibit 10(e) to the
Registrant's Annual Report on Form 10-K
for the year ended December 31, 1991
(filed March 26, 1991 - File No. 1-9148)
(the "1991 Form 10-K").
10(e)* The Registrant's Non-Employee Directors' Stock Option Plan, as
amended and restated as of January 14, 2000. Exhibit 10(e) to the
1999 Form 10-K.
10(f)* The Registrant's 1988 Stock Option Plan, as amended and restated as
of January 14, 2000. Exhibit 10(f) to the 1999 Form 10-K.
10(g)* The Pittston Company Management
Performance Improvement Plan. Exhibit
10(g) to the 1999 Form 10-K.
10(h)* Form of change in control agreement
replacing all prior change in control
agreements and amendments and
modifications thereto, between the
Registrant (or a subsidiary) and various
officers of the Registrant. Exhibit
10(l)(ii) to the 1997 Form 10-K.
10(i)* Form of Indemnification Agreement entered
into by the Registrant with its directors
and officers. Exhibit 10(l) to the 1991
Form 10-K.
10(j)* (i) Registrant's Retirement Plan for
Non-Employee Directors, as amended. Exhibit 10(g) to the
Third Quarter 1994 Form 10-Q.
(ii) Form of letter agreement dated as of September 16, 1994,
between the Registrant and its Non-Employee Directors
pursuant to Retirement Plan for Non-Employee Directors.
Exhibit 10(h) to the Third Quarter 1994 Form 10-Q.
10(k)* (i) Form of severance agreement between
the Registrant (or a subsidiary) and
various of the Registrant's officers.
Exhibit 10(o)(ii) to the 1997 Form
10-K.
10(l)* Registrant's Directors' Stock Accumulation
Plan, as amended and restated as of January
14, 2000. Exhibit 10(l) to the 1999 Form
10-K.
10(m)* Registrant's Amended and Restated Plan for
Deferral of Directors' Fees. Exhibit 10(o)
to the Registrant's Annual Report on Form
10-K for the year ended December 31, 1989
(filed March 24, 1990 - File No. 1-9148).
10(n) (i) Lease dated as of April 1, 1989,
between Toledo-Lucas County Port
Authority (the "Authority"), as
Lessor, and Burlington, as Lessee.
Exhibit 10(i) to the Registrant's
Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the
quarter ended June 30, 1989 (filed
August 11, 1989 - File No. 1-9148)
(the "Second Quarter 1989 Form 10-Q").
(ii) Lease Guaranty Agreement dated as of
April 1, 1989, between Burlington
(formerly Burlington Air Express
Management Inc.), as Guarantor, and
the Authority. Exhibit 10(ii) to the
Second Quarter 1989 Form 10-Q.
-22-
<PAGE>
(iii) Trust Indenture dated as of April 1, 1989 between the
Authority and Society Bank & Trust (formerly, Trustcorp.
Bank, Ohio) (the "Trustee"), as Trustee. Exhibit 10(iii) to
the Second Quarter 1989 Form 10-Q.
(iv) Assignment of Basic Rent and Rights Under a Lease and Lease
Guaranty dated as of April 1, 1989 from the Authority to the
Trustee. Exhibit 10(iv) to the Second Quarter 1989 Form
10-Q.
(v) Open-End First Leasehold Mortgage and Security Agreement
dated as of April 1, 1989 from the Authority to the Trustee.
Exhibit 10(v) to the Second Quarter 1989 Form 10-Q.
(vi) First Supplement to Lease dated as
of January 1, 1990, between the
Authority and Burlington, as Lessee.
Exhibit 10 to the Registrant's
Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for
the quarter ended March 31, 1990
(filed May 15, 1990 - File No.
1-9148).
(vii) Revised and Amended Second Supplement to Lease dated as of
September 1, 1990, between the Authority and Burlington.
Exhibit 10(i) to the Registrant's Quarterly Report on Form
10-Q for the quarter ended September 30, 1990 (filed
November 13, 1990 - File No. 1-9148) (the "Third Quarter
1990 Form 10-Q").
(viii) Amendment Agreement dated as of September 1, 1990, among
City of Toledo, Ohio, the Authority, Burlington and the
Trustee. Exhibit 10(ii) to the Third Quarter 1990 Form 10-Q.
(ix) Assumption and Non-Merger Agreement dated as of September 1,
1990, among Burlington, the Authority and the Trustee.
Exhibit 10(iii) to the Third Quarter 1990 Form 10-Q.
(x) First Supplemental Indenture between
Toledo-Lucas County Port Authority,
and Society National Bank, as
Trustee, dated as of March 1, 1994.
Exhibit 10.1 to the Registrant's
Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for
the quarter ended March 31, 1994
(filed May 12, 1994 - File No.
1-9148) (the "First Quarter 1994
Form 10-Q").
(xi) Third Supplement to Lease between
Toledo-Lucas County Port Authority,
as Lessor, and Burlington Air
Express Inc., as Lessee, dated as of
March 1, 1994. Exhibit 10.2 to the
First Quarter 1994 Form 10-Q.
(xii) Fourth Supplement to Lease between
Toledo-Lucas County Port Authority,
as Lessor, and Burlington Air
Express Inc., as Lessee, dated as of
June 1, 1991. Exhibit 10.3 to the
First Quarter 1994 Form 10-Q.
(xiii) Fifth Supplement to Lease between Toledo-Lucas County Port
Authority, as Lessor, and Burlington Air Express Inc., as
Lessee, dated as of December 1, 1996. Exhibit 10(r)(xiii) to
the Registrant's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year
ended December 31, 1996.
10(o) Credit Agreement, dated as of September 6, 2002, among The
Pittston Company, as Borrower, Certain of Its Subsidiaries,
as Guarantors, Various Lenders, Fleet National Bank, as
Co-Arranger and Documentation Agent, Wachovia Bank, National
Association, and the Bank of Nova Scotia, as Co-Arrangers
and Syndication Agents, JPMorgan Chase Bank, as
Administrative Agent, and J.P. Morgan Securities Inc., as
Sole Advisor, Lead Arranger and Bookrunner. Exhibit 10 to
the Registrant's Third Quarter 2002 Form 10-Q.
-23-
<PAGE>
10(p) (i) Credit Agreement, dated as of
November 12, 2002, among BAX Global
Inc., Brink's, Incorporated, and
certain of their subsidiaries, as
Borrowers, the Registrant as
Guarantor and Bayerische Hypo-Und
Vereinsbank AG.
(ii) Guaranty, dated as of November 12, 2002, between the
Registrant, as Guarantor, and Bayerische Hypo-Und
Vereinsbank AG.
10(q) (i) Credit Agreement, dated as of December 20, 2002, among
BAX Global Inc., Brink's, Incorporated and the Registrant,
as Borrowers and Guarantors, and ABN AMRO Bank, N.V.
(ii) Guaranty between BAX Global, as Guarantor, and ABN AMRO
Bank, N.V.
(iii) Guaranty between Brink's, Incorporated, as Guarantor, and
ABN AMRO Bank, N.V.
(iv) Guaranty between the Registrant, as
Guarantor, and ABN AMRO Bank, N.V.
10(r)* (i) Employment Agreement dated as
of May 4, 1998, between the
Registrant and M. T. Dan. Exhibit
10(a) to the Registrant's Quarterly
Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter
ended September 30, 1998 (the
"Third Quarter 1998 Form 10-Q").
(ii) Amendment No. 1 to Employment
Agreement between the Registrant
and Michael T. Dan. Exhibit 10 to
the Registrant's Quarterly Report
on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended
June 30, 2002.
10(s)* Executive Agreement dated as of May 4,
1998, between the Registrant and M. T. Dan.
Exhibit 10(b) to the Third Quarter 1998
Form 10-Q.
10(t)* Executive Agreement dated as of August 7,
1998, between the Registrant and R. T.
Ritter. Exhibit 10(c) to the Third Quarter
1998 Form 10-Q.
10(u)* Severance Agreement dated as of August 7,
1998, between the Registrant and R. T.
Ritter. Exhibit 10(d) to the Third Quarter
1998 Form 10-Q.
10(v) Trust Agreement for The Pittston Company
Employee Welfare Benefit Trust. Exhibit
10(t) to the 1999 Form 10-K.
10(w) (i) Note Purchase Agreement dated as of January 18, 2001,
between the Registrant and the Purchasers listed on Schedule
A thereto. Exhibit 10(u)(i) to the 2000 Form 10-K.
(ii) Form of Series A Promissory Note.
Exhibit 10(u)(ii) to the 2000 Form
10-K.
(iii) Form of Series B Promissory Note.
Exhibit 10(u)(iii) to the 2000 Form
10-K.
10(x) (i) Receivables Purchase Agreement dated
as of December 15, 2000, among BAX
Funding Corporation, BAX Global Inc.,
Liberty Street Funding Corp. and the
Bank of Nova Scotia. Exhibit 10(v)(i)
to the 2000 Form 10-K.
(ii) Purchase and Sale Agreement dated as of December 15, 2000,
among the Originators named therein, BAX Funding Corporation
and BAX Global Inc. Exhibit 10(v)(ii) to the 2000 Form 10-K.
10(y) (i) Note Purchase Agreement dated as
of April 11, 2002 between the
Registrant and the Purchasers set
forth on the signature page.
Exhibit 10(a)(i) to the Registrant's
Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for
the quarter ended March 31, 2002
(the "First Quarter 2002 Form 10-Q).
(ii) Form of Promissory Note.
Exhibit 10(a)(ii) to the First
Quarter 2002 Form 10-Q.
13 Parts of the 2002 Annual Report of the
Registrant.
21 Subsidiaries of the Registrant.
23 Consent of independent auditors.
-24-
<PAGE>
24 Powers of attorney.
99(a)* Amendment to Registrant's Pension-Retirement Plan relating to
preservation of assets of the Pension-Retirement Plan upon a
change in control. Exhibit 99 to the Registrant's Annual Report
on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1992 (filed March
20, 1993 - File No. 1-9148).
99(b) Certifications of Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial
Officer pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as adopted pursuant
to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
- --------------------------
*Management contract or compensatory plan or arrangement.
-25-
<PAGE>
</TEXT>
</DOCUMENT>
<DOCUMENT>
<TYPE>EX-10
<SEQUENCE>3
<FILENAME>hypocreditagreement.txt
<DESCRIPTION>HYPO BANK CREDIT AGREEMENT
<TEXT>
CREDIT AGREEMENT
DATED AS OF NOVEMBER 12, 2002
AMONG
BAX GLOBAL INC.,
BRINK'S, INCORPORATED,
AND CERTAIN OF THEIR SUBSIDIARIES,
AS BORROWERS,
THE PITTSTON COMPANY,
AS GUARANTOR,
AND
BAYERISCHE HYPO- UND VEREINSBANK AG,
AS BANK
<PAGE>
TABLE OF CONTENTS
ARTICLE I DEFINITIONS..................................................1
1.01 Defined Terms.....................................................1
1.02 Accounting Principles............................................14
ARTICLE II LOANS
2.01 Amounts and Terms of Commitment..................................14
2.02 Procedure for Incurring Loans....................................15
2.03 Conversion and Continuation Elections
with Respect to Outstanding Loans.....................................16
2.04 Termination or Reduction of the Commitment by BAX and Brink's....16
2.05 Optional Prepayments.............................................17
2.06 Repayment of Principal...........................................17
2.07 Interest.........................................................18
2.08 Fees.............................................................19
2.09 Computation of Fees and Interest.................................20
2.10 Payments by the Borrowers........................................20
2.11 Lending Office...................................................20
2.12 Extension of the Termination Date................................21
2.13 Certain Obligations Joint and Several............................21
ARTICLE III LETTERS OF CREDIT.........................................21
3.01 The Letters of Credit Commitment.................................21
3.02 Terms of the Letters of Credit...................................22
3.03 Procedure for Issuance of the Letters of Credit..................22
3.04 Drawings and Reimbursements......................................23
3.05 Reimbursement Obligations Absolute...............................23
ARTICLE IV TAXES, YIELD PROTECTION AND ILLEGALITY.....................24
4.01 Taxes...........................................................24
4.02 Illegality......................................................26
4.03 Increased Costs and Reduction of Return; Additional
Interest on LIBO Rate Loans.....................................26
4.04 Funding Losses..................................................27
4.05 Inability to Determine Rates....................................28
4.06 Certificate of the Bank.........................................28
4.07 Survival........................................................28
ARTICLE V CONDITIONS PRECEDENT..................................28
5.01 Conditions to Effectiveness of this Agreement...................28
5.02 Conditions to Subsequent Advances...............................30
5.03 Conditions for Participation by Additional Covered Subsidiaries.30
ARTICLE VI REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES.......................32
6.01 Corporate Existence.............................................32
6.02 Non-Contravention...............................................32
6.03 No Consent......................................................32
6.04 Binding Obligations.............................................32
6.05 Title to Properties.............................................32
6.06 Subsidiaries....................................................32
6.07 Financial Statements............................................33
6.08 Litigation......................................................33
6.09 Taxes...........................................................33
6.10 ERISA...........................................................33
6.11 No Default......................................................34
6.12 Federal Reserve Regulations.....................................34
6.13 Investment Company Act..........................................34
6.14 Environmental Matters...........................................34
6.15 Priority of Debt................................................35
6.16 Accuracy and Completeness of Information........................35
ARTICLE VII COVENANTS...........................................35
7.01 Post-Effective Date Transactions................................35
7.02 Affirmative Covenants...........................................36
7.03 Negative Covenants..............................................36
7.04 Reporting Requirements of the Guarantor.........................42
7.05 Additional Requirements of the Guarantor and the Borrowers......44
ARTICLE VIII EVENTS OF DEFAULT..................................44
8.01 Event of Default................................................44
8.02 Remedies........................................................46
8.03 Rights Not Exclusive............................................47
ARTICLE IX MISCELLANEOUS........................................47
9.01 Amendments and Waivers..........................................47
9.02 Notices.........................................................47
9.03 No Waiver; Cumulative Remedies..................................48
9.04 Costs and Expenses..............................................48
9.05 Indemnities.....................................................48
9.06 Successors and Assigns..........................................49
9.07 Assignments and Participations..................................49
9.08 Confidentiality.................................................50
9.09 Counterparts....................................................50
9.10 Severability....................................................50
9.11 Governing Law and Jurisdiction..................................51
9.12 Waiver of Jury Trial............................................51
9.13 Inconsistencies with Other Documents............................51
9.14 Entire Agreement................................................52
SCHEDULES
Schedule 9.02 Addresses for Notices
EXHIBITS
Exhibit A Election to Participate for BAX Covered Subsidiaries
Exhibit B Election to Participate for Brink's Covered Subsidiaries
Exhibit C Guaranty
Exhibit D-1 Indemnity and Waiver Request for BAX Covered Subsidiary
Exhibit D-2 Indemnity and Waiver Request for Brink's Covered Subsidiary
<PAGE>
41
CREDIT AGREEMENT
This CREDIT AGREEMENT is entered into as of November 12, 2002 among (i)
BAX GLOBAL INC., a Delaware corporation ("BAX"), (ii) BRINK'S, INCORPORATED, a
Delaware corporation ("Brink's"), (iii) the following subsidiaries of Brink's
(collectively, the "Brink's Covered Subsidiaries"): BRINK'S DEUTSCHLAND GMBH, a
German limited liability company, BRINK'S BETEILIGUNGSGESELLSCHAFT MBH, a German
limited liability company, BRINK'S DIAMOND & JEWELRY SERVICE NV, a Belgium
corporation, BRINK'S NEDERLAND B.V., a Dutch corporation, and BRINK'S AUSTRALIA
PTY LTD., an Australian corporation (BAX, the BAX Covered Subsidiaries, Brink's,
the Brink's Covered Subsidiaries and any other Covered Subsidiaries that
hereafter become party hereto are hereinafter referred to collectively as the
"Borrowers" and sometimes individually as a "Borrower"), (v) THE PITTSTON
COMPANY, a Virginia corporation (the "Guarantor"), and (vi) BAYERISCHE HYPO- UND
VEREINSBANK AG (the "Bank").
WHEREAS, to finance working capital needs and capital expenditures, and
for other general corporate purposes, the Borrowers wish to establish with the
Bank a two-year revolving credit facility providing for revolving loans and
letters of credit of up to $35,000,000 in the aggregate maximum amount at any
time outstanding, and the Bank is willing to establish such credit facility on
the terms and conditions set forth herein;
NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the mutual agreements, provisions
and covenants contained herein, the parties hereto hereby agree as follows:
ARTICLE I
DEFINITIONS
1.01 DEFINED TERMS. In addition to the terms defined in the recitals to
this Agreement, the following terms have the following meanings:
"Advances" has the meaning assigned thereto in Section 2.01.
"Affiliate" means any Person directly or indirectly
Controlling, Controlled by, or under direct or indirect common Control
with, the Bank, including, without limitation, foreign offices of the
Bank.
"Agreement" means this Credit Agreement, as it may be amended,
supplemented or modified from time to time hereafter.
"Applicable LT Rating" means as to each of Moody's and S&P,
its rating of the Guarantor's senior, unsecured, long-term,
non-credit-enhanced debt for borrowed money (or of the unsecured
long-term debt of any other Person, the rating of which by Moody's and
S&P is based upon a senior, unsecured, non-credit-enhanced guarantee by
the Guarantor).
"Applicable Percentage" means, for purposes of calculating (a)
the interest rate applicable to Loans under Section 2.07, (b) the
Facility Fee under Section 2.08(a) or (c)
<PAGE>
the L/C Fees under Section
2.08(b), the applicable percentage set forth in the following tables
opposite the Applicable LT Rating:
<TABLE>
- ------------ ------------------ ------------------ ---------------------------------- -----------------------
<CAPTION>
PRICING APPLICABLE LT LOANS AND FEES FOR FINANCIAL FEES FOR PERFORMANCE
LEVEL RATING FACILITY FEE LETTERS OF CREDIT LETTERS OF CREDIT
- ------------ ------------------ ------------------ ---------------------------------- -----------------------
- ------------ ------------------ ------------------ ---------------------------------- -----------------------
<S> <C> <C> <C> <C>
I A-/A3 or above 0.125% 0.50% 0.3225%
- ------------ ------------------ ------------------ ---------------------------------- -----------------------
- ------------ ------------------ ------------------ ---------------------------------- -----------------------
II BBB+/Baa1 0.15% 0.725% 0.485%
- ------------ ------------------ ------------------ ---------------------------------- -----------------------
- ------------ ------------------ ------------------ ---------------------------------- -----------------------
III BBB/Baa2 0.1625% 0.9625% 0.6375%
- ------------ ------------------ ------------------ ---------------------------------- -----------------------
- ------------ ------------------ ------------------ ---------------------------------- -----------------------
IV BBB-/Baa3 0.225% 1.15% 0.765%
- ------------ ------------------ ------------------ ---------------------------------- -----------------------
- ------------ ------------------ ------------------ ---------------------------------- -----------------------
V BB+/Ba1 0.30% 1.325% 0.885%
- ------------ ------------------ ------------------ ---------------------------------- -----------------------
- ------------ ------------------ ------------------ ---------------------------------- -----------------------
VI BB/Ba2 or below 0.40% 1.475% 0.9825%
- ------------ ------------------ ------------------ ---------------------------------- -----------------------
</TABLE>
For purposes of the foregoing, (i) if the Applicable LT
Ratings established by Moody's and S&P differ but correspond to
consecutive Pricing Levels, then the Pricing Level with the lower
number (i.e., corresponding to the better rating) shall apply (i.e., if
Moody's and S&P's Applicable LT Ratings correspond to Pricing Level I
and Pricing Level II, then Pricing Level I shall apply), and (ii) if
the Applicable LT Ratings established by Moody's and S&P differ but
correspond to non-consecutive Pricing Levels, then the Pricing Level
with a higher number (i.e., corresponding to the worse rating) minus
one shall apply (i.e., if Moody's and S&P's Applicable LT Ratings
correspond to Pricing Levels I and IV, then Pricing Level III shall
apply).
The Applicable Percentage shall be adjusted on the date five
(5) Business Days after the date of any change in the Applicable LT
Ratings. Each Applicable Percentage shall be effective from such
adjustment date until the next such adjustment date. Adjustments in the
Applicable Percentages shall be effective as to existing Advances as
well as any new Advance made thereafter.
"Approved Currencies" means Dollars and other currencies as
are available to be lent to a Borrower by the Lending Office and which
are freely transferable and convertible into Dollars.
"Assignee" has the meaning assigned thereto in Section 9.07.
"Bank" has the meaning assigned thereto in the preamble.
"Bankruptcy Code" means the Federal Bankruptcy Reform
Act of 1978 (12 U.S.C.ss.101, et seq.).
<PAGE>
"Base Rate" means the higher of:
(a) the rate of interest publicly announced from time
to time by the Bank as its "reference rate" or its "prime
rate" (which publicly announced rate is a rate set by the Bank
based upon various factors including the Bank's costs and
desired return, general economic conditions and other factors,
and is used as a reference point for pricing some loans, which
may be priced at, above, or below such announced rate); and
(b) one-half percent per annum above the latest
Federal Funds Rate.
Any change in the reference rate or prime rate announced by
the Bank shall take effect at the opening of business on the day
specified in the public announcement of such change.
"Base Rate Loan" means a Loan that bears interest based on the
Base Rate.
"BAX" has the meaning assigned thereto in the preamble.
"BAX Covered Subsidiaries" means the BAX Covered Subsidiaries
listed in the recitals to this Agreement, and any other Subsidiary of
BAX as to which an executed Election to Participate in the form of
Exhibit A hereto shall have been delivered to and approved by the Bank
in accordance with Section 5.03.
"Borrower" has the meaning assigned thereto in the preamble.
"Brink's" has the meaning assigned thereto in the preamble.
"Brink's Covered Subsidiaries" means the Brink's Covered
Subsidiaries listed in the recitals to this Agreement, and any other
Subsidiary of Brink's as to which an executed Election to Participate
in the form of Exhibit B hereto shall have been delivered to and
approved by the Bank in accordance with Section 5.03.
"Business Day" means any day other than a Saturday, Sunday or
other day on which commercial banks in Munich, Germany or the relevant
Lending Office are authorized or required by law to close.
"Capital Adequacy Regulation" means any guideline, request or
directive of any central bank or other Governmental Authority, or any
other law, rule or regulation, whether or not having the force of law,
in each case, regarding capital adequacy of any bank or of any
corporation controlling a bank.
"Capital Lease" means any lease of property which should be
capitalized on the lessee's balance sheet in accordance with GAAP; and
"Capital Lease Obligation" means the amount of the liability so
capitalized.
<PAGE>
"Change in Control" shall be deemed to have occurred if (i)
any person or group of persons (within the meaning of Section 13(d) of
the Securities Exchange Act, as amended) shall obtain, directly or
indirectly, beneficially or of record, ownership or control in one or
more series of transactions of shares representing more than 35% of the
aggregate ordinary voting power represented by the issued and
outstanding capital stock of the Guarantor, provided that such person
or group of persons shall be deemed to have obtained such ownership or
control on the date thirty days after the date that such person or
group of persons actually obtains such ownership or control; (ii) a
majority of the seats on the board of directors of the Guarantor shall
be occupied by persons other than (x) directors of the Guarantor on the
date of this Agreement or (y) directors initially nominated or
appointed by action of the board of directors of the Guarantor; or
(iii) there shall have occurred, under any indenture or other
instrument evidencing Debt of the Guarantor or any Restricted
Subsidiary for borrowed money in excess of $25,000,000, a "change in
control" or similar event (as defined in such indenture or other
instrument evidencing such Debt) beyond any grace period permitted
therein obligating the Guarantor or any Restricted Subsidiary to
repurchase, redeem or repay all or any part of such Debt or any capital
stock provided for therein.
"Code" means the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended.
"Commercial Letter of Credit" means a documentary letter of
credit which is drawable upon presentation of documents evidencing the
sale or shipment of goods purchased by a Borrower or any Covered
Subsidiary in the ordinary course of its business.
"Commitment" means the commitment of the Bank under this
Agreement to make Advances in an aggregate principal amount not to
exceed $35,000,000, as such amount may be reduced from time to time
pursuant to Section 2.01(a), Section 2.01(b) or Section 2.04(a).
"Consolidated Debt", "Consolidated Lease Rentals", and
"Consolidated Net Worth" means the Debt, Lease Rentals and Net Worth,
as the case may be, of the Guarantor and its Restricted Subsidiaries,
if any, all consolidated in accordance with GAAP and after giving
appropriate effect to any outside minority interests in the Restricted
Subsidiaries.
"Consolidated EBITDA" shall mean, for the Guarantor and its
Restricted Subsidiaries for any period, an amount equal to the sum of
(a) Consolidated Net Income for such period plus (b) to the extent
deducted in determining Consolidated Net Income for such period, (i)
Consolidated Interest Expense, (ii) income tax expense, (iii)
depreciation, depletion and amortization, and (iv) all other non-cash
charges, determined on a consolidated basis in accordance with GAAP
after giving appropriate effect to any outside minority interests in
the Restricted Subsidiaries.
"Consolidated Interest Expense" means, for any period, as
applied to the Guarantor and its Restricted Subsidiaries, all interest
expense (whether paid or accrued) and capitalized interest, including
without limitation (a) the amortization of debt discount and premium,
(b) the interest component under Capital Leases, and (c) the implied
interest component, discount or other similar fees or charges in
connection with any asset securitization program in each case
determined on a consolidated basis in accordance with GAAP after giving
appropriate effect to any outside minority interests in the Restricted
Subsidiaries.
<PAGE>
"Consolidated Net Income" means, for any period, the net
income, after taxes, of the Guarantor and its Restricted Subsidiaries
for such period determined on a consolidated basis in accordance with
GAAP after giving appropriate effect to any outside minority interests
in the Restricted Subsidiaries, but excluding, to the extent reflected
in determining such net income, (a) any extraordinary gains and losses
for such period, (b) for any period ending before January 1, 2003, any
loss arising from or relating to the initial classification of any
portion of the Pittston Minerals Group, Inc., and its Subsidiaries as
discontinued operations and any subsequent adjustments associated with
the disposition of such discontinued operations, (c) any non-cash
impairment, write-down or write-off in the book value of any assets,
and (d) any non-cash loss in connection with the disposition of any
assets.
"Consolidated Net Worth" means, as of any date, as applied to
the Guarantor and its Restricted Subsidiaries, shareholders' equity or
net worth as determined and computed on a consolidated basis in
accordance with GAAP after giving effect to any outside minority
interests in the Restricted Subsidiaries, provided that in determining
"Consolidated Net Worth" there shall be (a) included any issuance of
preferred stock by the Guarantor and (b) excluded (i) any extraordinary
gains or losses, (ii) any loss arising from or related to the initial
classification of any portion of the Pittston Minerals Group, Inc., and
its Subsidiaries as discontinued operations and any subsequent
adjustment associated with the disposition of such discontinued
operations, (iii) any non-cash impairment, write-down or write-off in
the book value of any assets (including any reduction in shareholders'
equity in connection with a reduction in the value of a prepaid Plan or
foreign pension plan), and (iv) any loss in connection with the
disposition of assets.
"Contaminant" shall mean any waste, hazardous material,
hazardous substance, toxic substance, hazardous waste, special waste,
petroleum or petroleum derived substance or waste, including any such
pollutant, material, substance or waste regulated under any
Environmental Law.
"Control", "Controlling" and "Controlled" means the power,
direct or indirect, of one Person to direct or cause the direction of
the management and policies of another, whether by contract, through
voting securities or otherwise.
"Covered Subsidiaries" means the BAX Covered Subsidiaries and
the Brink's Covered Subsidiaries.
"Debt" of any Person means all obligations which would, in
accordance with GAAP, be classified upon its balance sheet as debt, and
in any event includes any Capital Lease Obligation and all debt of any
other Person:
<PAGE>
(a) guaranteed, directly or indirectly in any manner,
by the Person or endorsed (otherwise than for collection or
deposit in the ordinary course of business) or discounted with
recourse or debt which has the substantially equivalent or
similar economic effect of being guaranteed by the Person, or
of otherwise making the Person contingently liable therefor,
through an agreement or otherwise, including, without
limitation, an agreement (i) to purchase, or to advance or
supply funds for the payment or purchase of, the debt, (ii) to
purchase, sell or lease property, products, materials or
supplies, or transportation or services, primarily for the
purpose of enabling such other Person to pay the debt or to
assure the owner of the debt against loss, regardless of the
delivery or nondelivery of the property, products, materials
or supplies, or transportation or services or (iii) to make
any loan, advance, capital contribution or other investment in
such other Person to assure a minimum equity, asset base,
working capital or other balance sheet condition for any date,
or to provide funds for the payment of any liability, dividend
or stock liquidation payment, or otherwise to supply funds to
or in any manner invest in such other Person, it being
expressly understood and agreed, however, the Lease Rentals
under Leases shall not be considered Debt; or
(b) secured by an Encumbrance in respect of property
owned by the Person even through the Person has not assumed or
become liable for the payment of such debt.
"Default" means any event or circumstance which, with the
giving of notice, the lapse of time, or both, would (if not cured or
otherwise remedied) constitute an Event of Default.
"Dollars", "dollars" and "$" each mean lawful money of the
United States.
"Dollar Equivalent" means (a) in relation to an amount
denominated in Dollars, the amount thereof and (b) in relation to an
amount denominated in any Approved Currency other than Dollars, the
amount of Dollars that can be purchased with such Approved Currency at
the spot rate of exchange determined by the Bank in accordance with its
customary practices on the date of determination.
"Effective Date" means the date on which all conditions
precedent set forth in Section 5.01 are satisfied or waived by the
Bank.
"Encumbrance" means, as to any Person, any mortgage, lien,
pledge, adverse claim, charge, security interest or other encumbrance
in or on, or any interest or title of any vendor, lender or other
secured party to or of the Person under any conditional sale or other
title retention agreement or Capital Lease with respect to, any
property or asset of the Person, or the signing or filing of a
financing statement which names the Person as debtor, or the signing of
any security agreement authorizing any other party as the secured party
thereunder to file any financing statement.
<PAGE>
"Environmental Laws" means any and all federal, state, local
and foreign statutes, laws, regulations, ordinances, rules, judgements,
orders, decrees, permits, licenses, agreements or other governmental
restrictions relating to the environment or to emissions, discharges or
releases of pollutants, contaminants, petroleum products, or toxic or
hazardous substances or wastes into the environment, including ambient
air, surface water, groundwater, or land, or otherwise relating to the
manufacture, processing, distribution, use, treatment, storage,
disposal, transport or handling of pollutants, contaminants, petroleum
or petroleum products, or toxic or hazardous substances or wastes or
the clean up or other remediation thereof.
"ERISA" means the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of
1974, as amended.
"ERISA Affiliate" means any entity or trade or business,
whether or not incorporated, that, together with any Borrower, is
treated as a single employer under Section 414 of the Code.
"Extension Request" shall have the meaning assigned thereto in
Section 2.12.
"Event of Default" means any of the events or circumstances
specified in Section 8.01.
"Facility Fee" has the meaning assigned thereto in Section
2.08(a).
"Federal Funds Rate" means, for any day, the rate set forth in
the weekly statistical release designated as H.15(519), or any
successor publication, published by the Federal Reserve Board
(including any such successor, "H.15(519)") for such day opposite the
caption "Federal Funds (Effective)". If on any relevant day such rate
is not yet published in H.15(519), the rate for such day will be the
rate set forth in the daily statistical release designated as the
Composite 3:30 p.m. Quotations for U.S. Government Securities, or any
successor publication, published by the Federal Reserve Bank of New
York (including any such successor, the "Composite 3:30 p.m.
Quotation") for such day under the caption "Federal Funds Effective
Rate". If on any relevant day the appropriate rate for such previous
day is not yet published in either H.15(519) or the Composite 3:30 p.m.
Quotations, the rate for such day will be the arithmetic mean of the
rates for the last transaction in overnight Federal funds arranged
prior to 9:00 a.m. (New York time) on that day by each of three leading
brokers of Federal funds transactions in New York City selected by the
Bank.
"Federal Reserve Board" means the Board of Governors of the
Federal Reserve System or any successor thereof.
"Financial Letter of Credit" has the meaning assigned thereto
in Section 3.01(a).
"GAAP" means United States generally accepted accounting
principles set forth from time to time in the opinions and
pronouncements of the Accounting Principles Board and the American
Institute of Certified Public Accountants and statements and
pronouncements of the Financial Accounting Standards Board (or agencies
with similar
<PAGE>
functions of comparable stature and authority within the
accounting profession), or in such other statements by such other
entity as may be in general use by significant segments of the United
States accounting profession, which are applicable to the circumstances
as of the date of determination.
"Governmental Authority" means any nation or government, any
state or other political subdivision thereof, any central bank (or
similar monetary or regulatory authority) thereof, any entity
exercising executive, legislative, judicial, regulatory or
administrative functions of or pertaining to government, and any
corporation or other entity owned or controlled, through stock or
capital ownership or otherwise, by any of the foregoing.
"Guarantor Credit Agreement" means that certain $350,000,000
Credit Agreement, dated as of September 6, 2002 among the Guarantor (as
borrower), the lenders party thereto, Fleet National Bank, as a
co-arranger and documentation agent, Wachovia Bank, National
Association and The Bank Of Nova Scotia, as co-arrangers and
syndication agents, and JPMorgan Chase Bank, as administrative agent,
as it may be amended, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to
time hereafter.
"Guarantor" has the meaning assigned thereto in the preamble.
"Guaranty" means the Guaranty of the Guarantor, substantially
in the form of Exhibit C hereto.
"Hedging Agreements" means interest rate protection
agreements, foreign currency exchange agreements, other interest or
exchange rate hedging, cap or collar arrangements or arrangements
designed to protect the Guarantor or any of its Subsidiaries against
fluctuations in the prices of commodities.
"Insolvency Proceeding" means (a) any case, action or
proceeding before any court or other Governmental Authority relating to
bankruptcy, reorganization, insolvency, liquidation, receivership,
dissolution, winding-up or relief of debtors, or (b) any general
assignment for the benefit of creditors, composition, marshalling of
assets for creditors or other, similar arrangement in respect of its
creditors generally or any substantial portion of its creditors; and,
in each case, undertaken under United States federal or State or
foreign law, including the Bankruptcy Code.
"Interest Coverage Ratio" means, as of the last day of any
fiscal quarter, the ratio of (a) Consolidated EBITDA to (b)
Consolidated Interest Expense, in each case for the period of four
consecutive fiscal quarters ending as of such day.
"Interest Payment Date" means (i) with respect to all Loans,
the Termination Date, (ii) with respect to LIBO Rate Loans, the last
day of the Interest Period applicable to each such Loan, and, if any
such Interest Period exceeds three months, interest shall also be paid
on the date which falls three months after the beginning of such
Interest Period, and (iii) with respect to Base Rate Loans and Optional
Rate Loans, the last Business Day of each calendar quarter.
<PAGE>
"Interest Period" means, with respect to any LIBO Rate Loan,
the period commencing on the Business Day such Loan is disbursed,
continued or converted to a Base Rate Loan or Optional Rate Loan, and
in each case ending on the date one, two, three or six months
thereafter, as selected by the relevant Borrower in its notice of
borrowing or notice of conversion or continuation, provided that:
(i)i if any Interest Period would otherwise end on a
day which is not a Business Day, that Interest Period shall be
extended to the next succeeding Business Day unless the result
of such extension would be to carry such Interest Period into
another calendar month, in which event such Interest Period
shall end on the immediately preceding Business Day; and
(ii)ii any Interest Period that begins on the last
Business Day of a calendar month (or on a day for which there
is no numerically corresponding day in the calendar month at
the end of such Interest Period) shall end on the last
Business Day of the calendar month at the end of such Interest
Period.
"Labor Laws" means any and all federal, state, local and
foreign statutes, laws, regulations, ordinances, rules, judgements and
orders relating to employment, equal employment opportunity,
nondiscrimination, immigration, wages, hours, benefits, collective
bargaining, the payment of social security and similar taxes,
occupational safety and health, and plant closing.
"L/C Application" has the meaning assigned thereto in Section
3.03(b).
"L/C Fee" has the meaning assigned thereto in Section 2.08(b).
"L/C Related Documents" has the meaning assigned thereto in
Section 3.05(a).
"Lease" means a lease, other than a Capital Lease, of real or
personal property; and "Lease Rentals" for any period means the sum of
the rental and other obligations to be paid by the lessee under a Lease
during the remaining term of such Lease (excluding any extension or
renewal thereof at the option of the lessor or the lessee unless such
option has been exercised), excluding any amount required to be paid by
the lessee (whether or not therein designated as rental or additional
rental) on account of maintenance and repairs, insurance, taxes,
assessment, water rater and similar charges.
"Lending Office" has the meaning assigned thereto in Section
2.11.
"Letter of Credit" means any stand-by letter of credit issued
by a Lending Office pursuant to Section 3.03 and may be a Financial
Letter of Credit or a Performance Letter of Credit.
"Letter of Credit Obligations" means, in respect of any Letter
of Credit as at any date of determination, the sum of (a) the maximum
aggregate amount which is then available to be drawn under such Letter
of Credit plus (b) the aggregate amount of all Reimbursement
Obligations then outstanding with respect to such Letter of Credit.
<PAGE>
"Leverage Ratio" means, as of any date, the ratio of (a) the
sum of (i) Consolidated Debt as of such date, plus (ii) the amount by
which (A) the aggregate amount, as of the preceding December 31 (or as
of such date, if such date is December 31), of Consolidated Lease
Rentals under noncancellable Leases entered into by the Guarantor or
any of its Restricted Subsidiaries, discounted to present value at 10%
and net of aggregate minimum noncancellable sublease rentals,
determined on a basis consistent with Note 12 to the Guarantor's
consolidated financial statements at and for the period ended December
31, 2001, included in the Guarantor's 1992 Annual Report to
shareholders, exceeds (B) $350,000,000, to (b) the sum of (i) the
amount determined pursuant to clause (a), plus (ii) Consolidated Net
Worth as of such date.
"LIBO Rate" means, for each Interest Period in respect of any
LIBO Rate Loan:
(a) the rate per annum (carried out to the fifth
decimal place) equal to the rate determined by the relevant
Lending Office to be the offered rate that appears on the page
of the Telerate Screen that displays an average British
Bankers Association Interest Settlement Rate (such page
currently being page number 3750) for deposits in dollars (for
delivery on the first day of such Interest Period) with a term
equivalent to such Interest Period, determined as of
approximately 11:00 a.m. (London time) two Business Days prior
to the first day of such Interest Period, or
(b) in the event the rate referenced in the preceding
subsection (a) does not appear on such page or service or such
page or service shall cease to be available, the rate per
annum (carried to the fifth decimal place) equal to the rate
determined by the Bank to be the offered rate on such other
page or other service that displays an average British Bankers
Association Interest Settlement Rate for deposits in dollars
(for delivery on the first day of such Interest Period) with a
term equivalent to such Interest Period, determined as of
approximately 11:00 a.m. (London time) two Business Days prior
to the first day of such Interest Period, or
(c) in the event the rates referenced in the
preceding subsections (a) and (b) are not available, the rate
per annum determined by the Bank as the rate of interest at
which dollar deposits (for delivery on the first day of such
Interest Period) in same day funds in the approximate amount
of the applicable LIBO Rate Loan and with a term equivalent to
such Interest Period would be offered by the Bank's London
Branch to major banks in the offshore dollar market at their
request at approximately 11:00 a.m. (London time) two Business
Days prior to the first day of such Interest Period.
"LIBO Rate Loan" means a Loan that bears interest based on the
LIBO Rate.
"Loan" means an advance of funds by a Lending Office to a
Borrower pursuant to Section 2.02, and may be a Base Rate Loan, an
Optional Rate Loan or a LIBO Rate Loan.
<PAGE>
"Loan Documents" means this Agreement and all documents
delivered to the Bank or any Lending Office in connection herewith,
including without limitation, the Notes, the Guaranty, any L/C Related
Documents and any other documentation executed at the request of any
Lending Office, all as may be amended, restated or modified.
"Long Term Debt" of any Person means all Debt which would, in
accordance with GAAP, be classified upon its balance sheet as long term
debt, excluding any portion thereof which would, in accordance with
GAAP, be classified thereon as a current liability, and in any event
includes (a) any obligation for borrowed money outstanding under a
revolving credit or similar agreement providing for borrowing (and
renewals and extensions thereof) over a period of more than one year
after the creation of such agreement notwithstanding that any
obligation thereunder may be payable on demand or within one year after
the creation thereof, (b) any Capital Lease Obligation and (c) any
guarantee or equivalent or similar obligation under any agreement
specified in subsection (a) of the definition of Debt with respect to
Debt of another Person of the kind otherwise described in this
definition.
"Margin Stock" shall have the meaning given such term in
Regulation U promulgated by the Federal Reserve Board.
"Material Adverse Effect" means a material adverse change in,
or a material adverse effect upon the financial condition or results of
operations of the Guarantor and its Restricted Subsidiaries taken as a
whole that would impair the Borrowers' and the Guarantor's ability to
perform their respective obligations under this Agreement and the
Guaranty.
"Maturity Date" means November 12, 2004.
"Minority Owned Borrower" has the meaning assigned thereto in
Section 2.01(b).
"Moody's" means Moody's Investors Service, Inc.
"Multiemployer Plan" shall mean a multiemployer plan within
the meaning of Section 4001(a)(3) of ERISA to which any Borrower or any
ERISA Affiliate contributes or has, on or after September 25, 1980,
between obligated to contribute.
"Munich Office" means the Bank's office in Munich, Germany at
the address set forth in Section 9.02 hereof.
"Net Worth" of any Person means, at any time, its
shareholders' equity at such time determined in accordance with GAAP,
provided that in determining "Net Worth" there shall be included any
issue of preferred stock of such Person and, further provided that, in
determining "Net Worth" there shall be disregarded (i) any non-cash
write-down or write-off in the book value of any asset, (ii) any loss
on the sale of any asset or (iii) any change in shareholders' equity
attributable to a change in GAAP or the Guarantor's initial
implementation of a generally accepted accounting principle or a
Financial Accounting Standard issued by the Financial
<PAGE>
Accounting Standards Board, all after December 31, 1993.
"New York Office" means the Bank's office in New York, New
York. "Note" has the meaning assigned thereto in Section
2.01(c).
"Obligations" means all Loans, Letter of Credit Obligations
and other indebtedness, advances, Debts, liabilities, obligations,
covenants and duties owing by a Borrower to the Bank, any Lending
Office or any other Person required to be indemnified by that Borrower
under any Loan Document, of any kind or nature, present or future,
whether or not evidenced by any note, guaranty or other instrument,
arising under this Agreement, under any other Loan Document, whether
arising under, out of, or in connection with, any checks, notes,
drafts, bills of exchange, acceptances, orders, instruments of
guarantee and indemnity or other instruments for the payment of money,
or in any other manner, and also including any other document made,
delivered or given in connection therewith, and each other obligation
and liability, whether direct or indirect, absolute or contingent, due
or to become due, or now existing or hereafter incurred, of any
Borrower to the Bank or any Lending Office arising under any Loan
Document, whether on account of principal, interest, reimbursement
obligations, fees, indemnities, costs, expenses (including, without
limitation, all fees and disbursements of counsel to the Bank,
including, without limitation, allocated costs of staff counsel) or
otherwise, whether or not for the payment of money, whether arising by
reason of an extension of credit, loan, guaranty, indemnification or in
any other manner, whether direct or indirect (including those acquired
by assignment), absolute or contingent, due or to become due, now
existing or hereafter arising and however acquired.
"Optional Rate" means as to any Optional Rate Loan a rate of
interest per annum to be determined at the time a Borrower gives a
notice of borrowing for an Optional Rate Loan, which may be a fixed
rate or a variable rate, and which shall be at a mutually agreeable
margin over the cost to the applicable Lending Office to obtain Dollars
or the Approved Currency in the jurisdiction in which the Optional Rate
Loan is to be made.
"Optional Rate Loan" means any Loan requested by a Borrower
which does not exceed $1,000,000, which is to be borrowed for a term
that does not correspond to any available Interest Period or which
otherwise bears interest at a rate negotiated by a Borrower and the
Bank.
"Performance Letter of Credit" has the meaning assigned
thereto in Section 3.01(a).
"Performance Letter of Credit Sublimit" means $3,000,000, as
such sublimit may be increased or reduced from time to time.
"Person" means an individual, partnership, limited liability
company, corporation, business trust, joint stock company, trust,
unincorporated association, joint venture or Governmental Authority.
<PAGE>
"PBGC" shall mean the Pension Benefit Guaranty Corporation and
any entity succeeding to any or all of its functions under ERISA.
"Plan" shall mean a pension plan within the meaning of Section
3(2) of ERISA subject to Title IV of ERISA which any Borrower or any
ERISA Affiliate maintains or to which any Borrower or any ERISA
Affiliate contributes other than a Multiemployer Plan.
"Reimbursement Obligation" means in respect of any Letter of
Credit at any date of determination, the aggregate amount of all
drawings under such Letter of Credit honored by the issuing Lending
Office and not theretofore reimbursed by the relevant Borrower or by
the Guarantor.
"Reportable Event" shall have the meaning attributed thereto
in Section 4043 of ERISA but shall not include any event for which the
30-30 requirement in Section 4043 of ERISA has been waived under
regulations of the PBGC.
"Requirement of Law" means, as to any Person, any law
(statutory or common), treaty, rule or regulation or determination of a
court or an arbitrator or of a Governmental Authority, in each case
applicable to or binding upon the Person or any of its property or to
which the Person or any of its property is subject.
"Responsible Officer" means the chief executive officer,
president, chief financial officer or treasurer of a Borrower or the
Guarantor, or any other officer having substantially the same authority
and responsibility.
"Restricted Subsidiary" means any Person which is defined as a
"Restricted Subsidiary" from time to time pursuant to the Guarantor
Credit Agreement.
"Sale and Leaseback Transaction" means the sale by the
Guarantor or a Restricted Subsidiary to any Person (other than the
Guarantor or a Restricted Subsidiary) of any property or asset and, as
part of the same transaction or series of transactions, the leasing as
lessee by the Guarantor or any Restricted Subsidiary of the same or
another property or asset which it intends to use for substantially the
same purpose.
"S&P" means Standard & Poor's Ratings Services.
---
"Subsidiary" of a Person means (i) any corporation of which
more than 50% of the outstanding stock having by the terms thereof
ordinary voting power to elect a majority of the members of the board
of directors of such corporation (irrespective or whether or not at the
time stock of any other class or classes of such corporation shall have
or might have voting power by reason of the happening of any
contingency) is owned or controlled directly or indirectly by the
Person, or one or more of the Subsidiaries of the Person, or a
combination thereof, or (ii) any limited liability company of which
more than 50% of the outstanding equity interests is owned or
controlled directly or indirectly by the Person, or one or more of the
Subsidiaries of the Person, or a combination thereof.
"Taxes" has the meaning assigned thereto in Section 4.01(a).
<PAGE>
"Termination Date" has the meaning assigned thereto in Section
2.01.
"United States" and "U.S." each means the United States of America.
"Withholding Taxes" has the meaning assigned thereto in
Section 4.01(a).
1.02 ACCOUNTING PRINCIPLES.
---------------------
(a) Unless the context otherwise clearly requires, all accounting terms not
expressly defined herein shall be construed, and all financial computations
required under this Agreement shall be made, in accordance with GAAP,
consistently applied. All calculations made for the purposes of determining
compliance with this Agreement shall (except as otherwise expressly provided
herein) be made by application of GAAP applied on a basis consistent with the
most recent annual or quarterly financial statements delivered pursuant to
Section 7.04 (or, prior to the delivery of the first financial statements
pursuant to Section 7.04, consistent with the annual audited financial
statements referenced in Section 6.07); provided, however, if (a) the Guarantor
shall object to determining such compliance on such basis at the time of
delivery of such financial statements due to any change in GAAP or the rules
promulgated with respect thereto or (b) the Bank shall so object in writing
within 60 days after delivery of such financial statements, then such
calculations shall be made on a basis consistent with the most recent financial
statements delivered by the Guarantor to the Bank as to which no such objection
shall have been made.
(b) References herein to "fiscal year" and "fiscal quarter" refer to such
fiscal periods of the Guarantor.
ARTICLE II
LOANS
2.01 AMOUNTS AND TERMS OF COMMITMENT. The Bank agrees to make available to the
Borrowers (upon the request of BAX, in the case of the BAX Covered Subsidiaries,
or Brink's, in the case of the Brink's Covered Subsidiaries), from the Effective
Date until the Maturity Date or such earlier date on which the Bank terminates
the Commitment pursuant to Section 8.02(a) or BAX and Brink's terminate the
Commitment pursuant to Section 2.04(a) or such later date to which the Bank
agrees to extend the Commitment pursuant to Section 2.12 (the "Termination
Date"), committed funds in an aggregate amount of $35,000,000 (subject to
reduction pursuant to Section 2.04(a)), on the terms and conditions set forth in
this Agreement, as follows:
(a) The Commitment may be drawn upon for Loans or Letters of Credit
(collectively, "Advances") in Approved Currencies from the Effective Date until
the Termination Date in an aggregate principal amount not to exceed $35,000,000
(subject to reduction pursuant to Section 2.04(a)) at any time outstanding;
provided that: (1) the aggregate principal amount of all outstanding Loans
(after giving effect to any amount requested) shall not exceed the Commitment
minus the sum of all outstanding Letter of Credit Obligations.
<PAGE>
(b) Commitment Unavailable to Certain Borrowers; Acceleration of such
Borrowers' Advances. If at any time while the Commitment is outstanding BAX or
Brink's ceases to be a Subsidiary of the Guarantor, any BAX Covered Subsidiary
ceases to be a Subsidiary of BAX or any Brink's Covered Subsidiary ceases to be
a Subsidiary of Brink's (each such Borrower a "Minority Owned Borrower"), then
and in each such event, notwithstanding anything to the contrary herein (i) such
Borrower shall immediately, and without further act of the Bank, cease to be
permitted to draw upon the Commitment for any Advance, (ii) the unpaid principal
amount of all outstanding Loans and Reimbursement Obligations owed by such
Borrower, together with all interest and other amounts due the Bank with respect
thereto, shall automatically become due and payable without further act of the
Bank, (iii) such Borrower shall pay to the Bank an amount equal to the maximum
amount then available to be drawn under all Letters of Credit then outstanding
for the account of such Borrower, for deposit in a cash collateral account
maintained by the Bank, as security for such Letters of Credit, and (iv) upon
the Bank's receipt of full payment of the amounts contemplated by clauses (ii)
and (iii), such Borrower shall cease to be a Borrower hereunder or a party to
this Agreement.
(c) Documentation for Loans. Each Loan may be evidenced by (a) one or more
master promissory notes in form and substance acceptable to the
relevant Lending Office (each a "Note") or (b) by loan accounts
maintained by such Lending Office. The records attached as grids to the
Notes and the loan account and account records shall be conclusive
evidence, absent manifest error, of the amount of the Loans and the
interest and payments thereon. Any failure to record or any error in
doing so shall not, however, increase, limit or otherwise affect the
obligation hereunder of any Borrower to pay any amount owing with
respect to the Loans.
2.02 PROCEDURE FOR INCURRING LOANS. Each Loan shall be made upon the request of
a Borrower (and, in the case of a Borrower that is a BAX Covered Subsidiary, the
request of BAX, or, in the case of a Borrower that is a Brink's Covered
Subsidiary, the request of Brink's) to the Munich Office (which request must be
received by the Munich Office not later than 11:00 a.m. (Munich time)), unless
otherwise agreed by the Munich Office and such Lending Office, (a) on the
requested borrowing date, in the case of Base Rate Loans and Optional Rate Loans
to be funded to or in jurisdictions in the Munich Office's time zone and in time
zones following the Munich Office's time zone, (b) on the Business Day prior to
the requested borrowing date, in the case of Base Rate Loans and Optional Rate
Loans to be funded to or in jurisdictions in time zones ahead of the Munich
Office's time zone, and (c) three Business Days prior to the requested borrowing
date, in the case of LIBO Rate Loans), in a written notice in a form reasonably
satisfactory to the Munich Office specifying (i) the principal amount of the
Loan and whether it is to be denominated in Dollars or another Approved
Currency, (ii) the requested borrowing date, which shall be a Business Day;
(iii) whether the Loan is to be a Base Rate Loan, an Optional Rate Loan or a
LIBO Rate Loan; and (iv) if the requested Loan is a LIBO Rate Loan, the duration
of the Interest Period applicable to such Loan. If the notice of borrowing shall
fail to specify the duration of the Interest Period for any LIBO Rate Loan, such
Interest Period shall be one month. Each LIBO Rate Loan shall be in an amount of
not less than the Dollar Equivalent of $1,000,000. There shall be no minimum
amount for Optional Rate Loans and Base Rate Loans.
<PAGE>
2.03 CONVERSION AND CONTINUATION ELECTIONS WITH RESPECT TO OUTSTANDING LOANS.
-----------------------------------------------------------------------
(a) Any Borrower may upon irrevocable written notice to the Bank's Munich
Office and the applicable Lending Office in accordance with Section
2.03(b):
(i) elect to convert, on any Business Day, any Base Rate Loan made
to such Borrower into a LIBO Rate Loan or Optional Rate Loan;
or
(ii) elect to convert, on any Business Day, any Optional Rate Loan
made to such Borrower into a LIBO Rate Loan or Base Rate Loan;
or
(iii) elect to convert, on the last day of any Interest Period
therefor, any LIBO Rate Loan made to such Borrower into a Base
Rate Loan or Optional Rate Loan; or
(iv) elect, on the last day of the Interest Period with respect to
any LIBO Rate Loan made to such Person, to continue such Loan
as a LIBO Rate Loan denominated in the same currency for an
additional Interest Period.
(b) Any Borrower wishing to convert or continue a Loan as described in
Section 2.03(a) shall deliver by telex or fax, confirmed immediately in
writing, a notice of conversion or continuation (which notice must be
received by the Munich Office not later than 12:00 noon (Munich time),
unless otherwise agreed by such office) (i) on the date of conversion
of a LIBO Rate Loan into a Base Rate Loan or Optional Rate Loan, (ii)
three Business Days prior to the date of conversion of a LIBO Rate
Loan; and (iii) three Business Days prior to the date of continuation
of a LIBO Rate Loan, specifying:
(A) the proposed date of conversion or continuation;
(B) the aggregate principal amount of Loans to be converted or continued;
(C) the nature of the proposed conversion or continuation; and
(D) the duration of any requested Interest Period. If the
notice of conversion or continuation shall fail to
specify the duration of the Interest Period for any
LIBO Rate Loan, such Interest Period shall be one
month.
(c) During the existence of a Default or Event of Default, the Bank may
demand that any or all of the then-outstanding LIBO Rate Loans be
converted upon their expiration into Base Rate Loans. Such conversion
shall continue to be in effect so long as such Default or Event of
Default continues to exist.
2.04 TERMINATION OR REDUCTION OF THE COMMITMENT BY BAX AND BRINK'S.
-------------------------------------------------------------
(a) BAX and Brink's may, upon not less than three Business Days' prior
notice to the Bank and all other Borrowers then party hereto (i) terminate the
Commitment upon full prepayment of all outstanding Advances on the termination
date, or (ii) permanently reduce the Commitment to an amount not less than the
greater of (A) the Dollar Equivalent of the principal amount of all Advances to
remain outstanding on the reduction date and (B) $25,000,000. If the Commitment
is terminated in its entirety under this Section 2.04(a), the portion of the
Facility Fee accrued to, but not including, the effective date of such
termination shall be payable on the effective date of such termination without
any premium or penalty.
<PAGE>
(b) For the purpose of ensuring compliance with the maximum amount
available under the Commitment, the Bank shall on each date of a voluntary
reduction of the Commitment under Section 2.04(a) and on the last Business Day
of each calendar quarter, determine the Dollar Equivalent of the principal
amount of all then-outstanding Advances.
2.05 OPTIONAL PREPAYMENTS. Subject to Section 4.04, any Borrower may, at any
time or from time to time, upon at least three Business Days' notice to the
Munich Office and the applicable Lending Office, prepay Loans made to it in
whole or in part. Such notice of prepayment shall specify the date and amount of
such prepayment and whether such prepayment is of Base Rate Loans, Optional Rate
Loans, LIBO Rate Loans or any combination thereof. No such notice shall be
revocable by any Borrower after being given. Once such notice is given by any
Borrower, such Borrower shall make such prepayment, and the payment amount
specified in such notice shall be due and payable, on the date specified
therein, together (only in the case of prepayments of LIBO Rate Loans) with
accrued interest to each such date on the amount prepaid and the amounts, if
any, required pursuant to Section 4.04.
2.06 REPAYMENT OF PRINCIPAL.
----------------------
(a) Each Borrower shall repay on the Termination Date the principal amount
of the Loans made to it that are then outstanding.
(b) In the event that the Bank determines, based on its computation made in
accordance with Section 2.04(b), that the Dollar Equivalent of the
then-outstanding Loans and Letter of Credit Obligations exceeds the Commitment,
the Bank shall give notice to the Guarantor and the Borrowers of such fact and
of the amount of such excess. Within 30 days after the date on which the
Borrowers receive such notice, they shall prepay Loans, or collateralize the
Letter of Credit Obligations with cash (as set forth below), in the aggregate
amount of such excess. Any such prepayment shall be made together with accrued
but unpaid interest on the principal amount thereof and, in the case of LIBO
Rate Loans, any amounts required to be paid in connection therewith pursuant to
Section 4.04. Any prepayments pursuant to this Section 2.06(b) shall be applied,
first, to any Base Rate Loans and Optional Rate Loans then outstanding, second,
to LIBO Rate Loans having Interest Periods ending on the date of such
prepayment, and third, to the extent that the amounts referred to in clauses
"first" and "second" are not sufficient to satisfy the entire prepayment
requirement under this Section 2.06(b) or there are no such Loans outstanding on
the date such prepayment would be required, then the remaining amount that would
be required to be prepaid under this Section 2.06(b) shall be deposited in a
cash collateral account maintained by the Bank, to be held as security for the
Obligations hereunder pursuant to a cash collateral agreement to be entered into
in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Bank and the Borrowers, and
to be applied to the prepayment of LIBO Rate Loans at the end of the respective
Interest Periods therefor and to the payment of Reimbursement Obligations as the
same become due.
<PAGE>
2.07 INTEREST.
--------
(a) Subject to Section 2.07(c), each Loan funded by the Bank or any
Affiliate shall bear interest on the outstanding principal amount thereof from
the date when made until it becomes due at a rate per annum equal to the LIBO
Rate, the Optional Rate or the Base Rate, as selected pursuant to Section 2.02,
plus the Applicable Percentage for Loans.
(b) Interest on each Loan shall be payable in arrears on each Interest
Payment Date. Interest shall also be payable on the date of any prepayment of
LIBO Rate Loans pursuant to Section 2.05 for the portion of such Loans so
prepaid and upon payment (including prepayment) in full of LIBO Rate Loans;
provided, however, that interest payable pursuant to Section 2.07(c) shall be
payable on demand.
(c) While there shall be any default hereunder in the payment of principal,
interest, fees or any other amount owing hereunder or after acceleration, each
Borrower shall pay interest (after as well as before entry of judgment thereon
to the extent permitted by law) on the principal amount of all Obligations of
such Person that are due and unpaid, at a rate per annum determined by adding 1%
per annum to the interest rate then in effect for the applicable type of Loan,
and, in the case of Obligations other than Loans, at a rate per annum equal to
the Base Rate plus the Applicable Percentage for Loans plus 1%; provided,
however, that, with respect to any Obligation for which the payment of interest
has been determined by a Lending Office to be at a rate other than LIBO Rate,
the late payment rate shall be 1% per annum over such rate; and provided
further, that, on and after the expiration of any Interest Period applicable to
any LIBO Rate Loan outstanding on the date of occurrence of such Event of
Default or acceleration, the principal amount of such Loan shall, during the
continuation of such Event of Default or after acceleration, bear interest at a
rate per annum equal to the Base Rate plus the Applicable Percentage for Loans
plus 1%.
(d) Anything herein to the contrary notwithstanding, the obligations of the
Borrowers hereunder shall be subject to the limitation that payments of interest
shall not be required, for any period for which interest is computed hereunder,
to the extent (but only to the extent) that contracting for or receiving such
payment by the relevant Lending Office would be contrary to the provisions of
any applicable law limiting the highest rate of interest which may be lawfully
contracted for, charged or received by the relevant Lending Office, and in such
event the Borrowers shall pay the relevant Lending Office interest at the
highest rate permitted by applicable law.
<PAGE>
2.08 FEES.
----
(a) Facility Fee. The Borrowers shall pay to the Bank a facility fee in
Dollars in an amount equal to the product of (i)i the Applicable
Percentage for Facility Fee, times (ii)ii 25%, times (iii)iii the
Commitment, computed on a quarterly basis in arrears on the last
Business Day of each calendar quarter. Such Facility Fee shall accrue
from the Effective Date to the Termination Date and shall be due and
payable quarterly in arrears on the fifth Business Day following
receipt of an invoice from the Bank, with the final payment to be made
on the Termination Date.
(b) Letter of Credit Fees.
---------------------
(i) Each Borrower shall pay to the Bank a letter of credit fee
("L/C Fee") with respect to each Letter of Credit issued by
the Bank in an amount determined as follows:
(A) subject to clause (C) below, as to Performance
Letters of Credit, the Dollar Equivalent of the
average daily undrawn amount of such issued Letters
of Credit as reported by the Bank times the
Applicable Percentage for Performance Letters of
Credit then in effect;
(B) subject to clause (C) below, as to Financial Letters
of Credit, the Dollar Equivalent of the average daily
undrawn amount of such issued Letters of Credit as
reported by the Bank times the Applicable Percentage
for Financial Letters of Credit then in effect; and
(C) if the original face amount of a Letter of Credit
does not exceed $200,000, the L/C Fee will be
separately agreed upon by the Borrower and the Bank
or applicable Lending Office at the time such Letter
of Credit is issued.
Such fee shall accrue on such amount from the date of issuance
of each Letter of Credit (with such issuance date being deemed
to be the Effective Date in the case of the Outstanding LCs
that are to be continued hereunder as Performance Letters of
Credit or Financial Letters of Credit) until its expiration
date, taking into account any extensions of the expiration
date beyond the initial expiration date. Such fee shall be
payable quarterly in arrears on the last day of each calendar
quarter and on the date each Letter of Credit expires or is
fully drawn.
(ii) In addition to the letter of credit fees due the Bank
hereunder, each Borrower shall pay to any Lending Office
issuing a Letter of Credit (other than the Munich Office or
the New York Office) any standard amendment, negotiation or
other fees as such Lending Office may request at the time such
Letter of Credit is issued or amended.
(c) Arrangement Fee. The Borrowers shall pay to the Bank an initial
arrangement fee in the amount of $35,000 on the Effective Date.
<PAGE>
2.09 COMPUTATION OF FEES AND INTEREST.
--------------------------------
(a) All computations of interest payable in respect of Base Rate Loans at
all times as the Base Rate is determined by the Bank's "reference" or
"prime" rate shall be made on the basis of a year of 365 or 366 days,
as the case may be, and actual days elapsed. All other computations of
fees and interest under this Agreement shall be made on the basis of a
360-day year and actual days elapsed. Interest and fees shall accrue
during each period during which interest or such fees are computed from
and including the first day thereof to but excluding the last day
thereof.
(b) Each determination of an interest rate by the Bank pursuant to any
provision of this Agreement shall be conclusive and binding on the
Borrowers in the absence of manifest error.
2.10 PAYMENTS BY THE BORROWERS.
-------------------------
(a) All payments (including prepayments) to be made by any Borrower on
account of Obligations shall be made without set-off or counterclaim
and shall, except as otherwise expressly provided herein, be made to
the relevant Lending Office, in the currency in which the relevant type
of Obligation was denominated and in immediately available funds, no
later than 3:00 p.m. (local time) unless otherwise agreed, on the date
specified herein. Any payment which is received by a Lending Office
later than 3:00 p.m. (local time) shall be deemed to have been received
on the immediately succeeding Business Day and any applicable interest
or fee shall continue to accrue.
(b) Whenever any payment hereunder shall be stated to be due on a day other
than a Business Day, such payment shall be made on the next succeeding
Business Day, and such extension of time shall in such case be included
in the computation of interest or fees, as the case may be, subject to
the provisions set forth in the definition of "Interest Period" herein.
2.11 LENDING OFFICE. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained herein,
each Advance made for the account of any Borrower incorporated or otherwise
organized in the United States or any political subdivision thereof shall be
made by the Bank's New York Office, unless otherwise agreed to by the parties,
and each Advance made for the account of any Borrower incorporated or otherwise
organized in any foreign country shall be made by an Affiliate of the Bank
located in such country, if applicable, and otherwise as may be mutually agreed
upon by the Bank and such Borrower (the Bank's branch or office or such foreign
Affiliate, as the case may be, which is required to make a given Advance
hereunder is referred to as the "Lending Office" with respect to such Advance).
The Bank agrees to use its best efforts not to change the location of any
Lending Office or to transfer its interest in any Loan to an Assignee so as to
cause payments by any Borrower to be made to a Lending Office outside the
country in which such Borrower is incorporated or otherwise organized. If the
Bank intends to change the location of any such Lending Office and such change
would cause any Borrower to become liable to make payments to the Bank pursuant
to Article IV, such payments shall not be applicable unless the Bank has given
the Borrowers at least 30 days' prior notice of the change, unless the relevant
sections of Article IV provide for a different notice period.
<PAGE>
2.12 EXTENSION OF THE TERMINATION DATE. BAX and Brink's, by notice to the Bank
and the other Borrowers then party hereto (an "Extension Request") at any time
not less than 90 days prior to the Termination Date then in effect, request that
such Termination Date be extended for successive one-year terms. If in its sole
discretion the Bank agrees to grant the Extension Request, the Bank shall so
notify Brink's and BAX within 30 days after the Bank's receipt of the Extension
Request, whereupon the Termination Date shall be extended for one year.
2.13 CERTAIN OBLIGATIONS JOINT AND SEVERAL. BAX shall be jointly and severally
liable with each of the BAX Covered Subsidiaries for all Obligations of such BAX
Covered Subsidiary. Brink's shall be jointly and severally liable with each of
the Brink's Covered Subsidiaries for all Obligations of such Brink's Covered
Subsidiary. Other than as set forth herein, no Borrower shall be liable for the
Obligations of any other Borrower.
ARTICLE III
LETTERS OF CREDIT
3.01 THE LETTERS OF CREDIT COMMITMENT.
--------------------------------
(a) Letters of Credit denominated in Dollars or any other Approved Currency
may be issued under the Commitment for the following purposes: (i) "Financial
Letters of Credit" may be issued to any Person other than an Affiliate to secure
the payment by any Person of its financial obligations, or to provide counter or
"back-up" guarantees in support of bank guarantees, Letters of Credit or other
credit facilities afforded to a Borrower, or to support local currency
borrowings outside the United States, and (ii) "Performance Letters of Credit"
may be issued to secure the performance by any Person of its obligations, or to
guaranty or otherwise secure any Person's obligations relating to a bid, advance
payment or security deposit, retention release, custom and duty deferment
guaranty or bond, warranty or performance bond or other guaranty and shall
include Commercial Letters of Credit. No Lending Office shall be obligated to
issue any Letter of Credit if, after giving effect to such issuance, (a) the sum
of the (i) aggregate amount of Letter of Credit Obligations plus (ii) the
aggregate principal amount of outstanding Loans would exceed the Commitment, or
any Performance Letter of Credit if, after giving effect to such issuance, the
aggregate Letter of Credit Obligations allocable to the then outstanding
Performance Letters of Credit would exceed the Performance Letter of Credit
Sublimit, provided that for -------- purposes of determining the amount of
Letter of Credit Obligations under Performance Letters of Credit at any such
time, any portion of such amount that is denominated in an Approved Currency
shall be included in such amount as the Dollar Equivalent thereof at such time.
(b) No Lending Office shall be obligated to issue any Letter of Credit
hereunder if such issuance would conflict with, or cause such Lending Office to
be in violation of, any Requirements of Law, including any prohibition of the
Foreign Assets Control regulations of the United States Treasury Department, or
after the Bank or any Lending Office has promptly notified the applicable
Borrower that it cannot, for any reason, issue a particular Letter of Credit.
<PAGE>
3.02 TERMS OF THE LETTERS OF CREDIT.
------------------------------
(a) Performance Letters of Credit issued after the Effective Date shall not
have a term exceeding one year.
(b) No Letter of Credit may expire (including all rights of renewal) later
than the Termination Date, provided, however, that the Bank in its discretion
may elect to, and may elect to allow any other relevant Lending Office to, issue
Letters of Credit that expire after the relevant Termination Date, upon terms
and conditions acceptable to the Bank, including without limitation, cash
collateral provisions, it being understood and agreed that this Agreement shall
remain in full force and effect with respect to all such Letters of Credit until
they have expired and all related Letter of Credit Obligations have been paid in
full. Without limiting the generality of the foregoing, the applicable Borrower
will cash collateralize each Letter of Credit that remains outstanding and
undrawn as of the Termination Date by deposit of immediately available funds in
an amount equal to the undrawn amount of such Letter of Credit in a
non-interest-bearing account maintained with the Bank.
3.03 PROCEDURE FOR ISSUANCE OF THE LETTERS OF CREDIT.
-----------------------------------------------
(a) Each Letter of Credit to be issued after the Effective Date shall be
issued upon the request of a Borrower (and, in the case of a Borrower that is a
BAX Covered Subsidiary, the request of BAX, or, in the case of a Borrower that
is a Brink's Covered Subsidiary, the request of Brink's) received by the Bank's
Munich Office and any other relevant Lending Office not later than 12:00 noon
(local time), unless otherwise agreed by the Munich Office and the relevant
Lending Office, three (3) Business Days prior to the requested date of issuance.
Upon receipt of such request, the Bank and any other relevant Lending Office
will determine whether or not the issuance of such Letter of Credit would be
permitted pursuant to Section 3.01.
(b) Each request for issuance of a Letter of Credit shall be made in
writing by fax and confirmed by delivery of the original executed Letter of
Credit Application and Agreement, in the Bank's standard form or a similar form
if the relevant Lending Office uses a different form (each, an "L/C
Application"), not later than one (1) Business Day thereafter. Each request for
issuance of a Letter of Credit and each L/C Application shall specify, among
other things: (i) the proposed date of issuance (which shall be a Business Day);
(ii) the face amount of the Letter of Credit; (iii) the date of expiration of
the Letter of Credit; (iv) the name and address of the beneficiary thereof; (v)
the documents to be presented by the beneficiary of the Letter of Credit in case
of any drawing thereunder; (vi) the full text of any certificate to be presented
by the beneficiary in case of any drawing thereunder; and (vii) whether the
Letter of Credit is a Financial Letter of Credit or a Performance
Letter of Credit.
(c) Any request for an amendment to any previously-issued Letter of Credit
shall be received by the Bank and any Lending Office which issued the Letter of
Credit not later than 12:00 noon (local time), unless otherwise agreed by the
Bank and any such other Lending Office, two (2) Business Days prior to the date
of the proposed amendment in writing by fax. Each written request for an
amendment to a previously-issued Letter of Credit made by fax shall be in the
form of the relevant L/C Application signed by the relevant Borrower and, unless
otherwise agreed by the Munich Office and any Lending Office which issued the
Letter of Credit in accordance with the last sentence of Section 3.02(b), shall
not request an extension beyond the relevant Termination Date described in said
Section. Amendments and extensions shall be at the sole discretion of the Munich
Office and any Lending Office which issued the Letter of Credit.
<PAGE>
(d) Notwithstanding any provision of any L/C Application to the contrary,
in the event of any conflict between the terms of any such L/C Application and
the terms of this Agreement, the terms of this Agreement shall control with
respect to payment obligations, events of default, representations and
warranties, and covenants, except that such L/C Application may provide for
further warranties relating specifically to the transaction or affairs
underlying such Letter of Credit.
3.04 DRAWINGS AND REIMBURSEMENTS. Each Borrower hereby unconditionally and
irrevocably agrees to reimburse the relevant Lending Office for each payment
made by such Lending Office under any Letter of Credit issued for the account of
such Borrower. Such reimbursement shall be due and payable on the date the
relevant Lending Office makes such payment under such Letter of Credit. If such
reimbursement payment is not made when due, the amount thereof shall bear
interest from the date such reimbursement payment became due to the date the
relevant Lending Office is reimbursed therefor at a rate per annum equal to the
Base Rate plus 1% per annum or, with respect to any Reimbursement Obligation
denominated in a currency other than Dollars or euros, such other rate per annum
as is determined by the issuing Lending Office to be due pursuant to the
relevant L/C Related Documents, in all cases as permitted by applicable laws.
Such interest shall be payable on demand.
3.05 REIMBURSEMENT OBLIGATIONS ABSOLUTE. The obligations of the Borrowers to
reimburse the relevant Lending Office for payments made by such Lending Office
under any Letter of Credit honoring a demand for payment by the beneficiary
thereunder shall be irrevocable, absolute and unconditional under any and all
circumstances, including the following circumstances:
(a) any lack of validity or enforceability of this Agreement, any Letter of
Credit, any L/C Application or any other agreement or instrument
relating thereto (collectively, the "L/C Related Documents");
(b) any change in the time, manner or place of payment of, or in any other
term of, all or any of the obligations of any Borrower in respect of
any Letter of Credit or any other amendment or waiver of or any consent
to or departure from all or any of the L/C Related Documents;
(c) the existence of any claim, set-off, defense or other right that any
Borrower may have at any time against any beneficiary or any transferee
of any Letter of Credit (or any Person for whom any such beneficiary or
any such transferee may be acting), the Bank, any Lending Office or any
other Person, whether in connection with this Agreement, the
transactions contemplated by the L/C Related Documents or any unrelated
transaction;
<PAGE>
(d) any draft, certificate, statement or other document presented under any
Letter of Credit proving to be forged, fraudulent, invalid or
insufficient in any respect or any statement therein being untrue or
inaccurate in any respect other than if such payment resulted from the
gross negligence or willful misconduct of the relevant Lending Office;
(e) payment by the relevant Lending Office under any Letter of Credit
against presentation of a draft or certificate that does not comply
with the terms of the Letter of Credit other than if such payment
resulted from the gross negligence or willful misconduct of the
relevant Lending Office;
(f) any release or amendment or waiver of or consent to departure from
any guaranty, for all or any of the obligations of any Borrower in
respect of any Letter of Credit; or
(g) any other circumstance or happening whatsoever, whether or not similar
to any of the foregoing, including any other circumstance that might
otherwise constitute a defense available to, or a discharge of, any
Borrower or any account party other than a circumstance constituting a
breach of this Agreement by or the gross negligence or willful
misconduct on the part of the relevant Lending Office.
ARTICLE IV
TAXES, YIELD PROTECTION AND ILLEGALITY
4.01 TAXES.
-----
(a) Payments made hereunder and under any instrument executed hereunder
shall be made free and clear of, and without deduction for, any and all present
or future taxes, levies, imposts, duties, deductions, withholding and similar
charges ("Taxes") excluding, in the case of the Bank, each Lending Office and
each Assignee, Taxes (including franchise or receipts taxes) imposed on or in
respect of its net income, capital, or receipts, by the jurisdiction (or any
political subdivision thereof) under the laws of which the Bank or such Lending
Office or Assignee (as the case may be) (A) is organized, (B) has its principal
place of business, or (C) is, through an office or other fixed place of
business, deemed to be doing business or maintaining a permanent establishment
under any applicable income tax treaty (such non-excluded Taxes being
"Withholding Taxes"). If any Borrower or Guarantor shall be required by law to
deduct any Withholding Taxes from or in respect of any sum payable hereunder or
under any instrument executed hereunder, such Borrower or Guarantor:
(i) shall pay to the Bank, Lending Office or Assignee an
additional amount so that the net amount received and retained
by the Bank, Lending Office or Assignee after taking into
account such Withholding Taxes (and any additional Withholding
Taxes payable on account of any additional payment called for
by this sentence) will equal the full amount which would have
been received and retained by the Bank, Lending Office or
Assignee as if no such Withholding Taxes been paid, deducted,
or withheld;
(ii) shall make such deductions for Withholding Taxes; and
(iii) shall pay the full amount deducted to the relevant taxing
authority or other authority in accordance with applicable
law.
(b) Borrower shall indemnify the Bank, Lending Office or Assignee (as the
case may be) for (i) the full amount of any Withholding Taxes (including
interest and penalties thereon) that the Bank, Lending Office or Assignee
becomes liable for as a result of a Borrower's or Guarantor's failure to pay
such Withholding Taxes pursuant to Section 4.01 or applicable law.
<PAGE>
(c) Each Borrower will furnish the Bank, Lending Office or Assignee
original Withholding Tax receipts, notarized copies of Withholding Tax receipts
or such other appropriate documentation as will prove payment of tax in a court
of law applying U.S. Federal Rules of Evidence for all Taxes paid by such
Borrower pursuant to Section 4.01(a). The relevant Borrower will deliver such
receipts within a reasonable period after payment of any Withholding Taxes, but
in no event later than 60 days after the due date for the related Withholding
Tax.
(d) If the Bank, Lending Office or Assignee is entitled to a refund or
credit of Withholding Tax, it shall use reasonable efforts to pursue such refund
(and interest with respect thereto), and if it receives such refund or credit,
shall pay to the relevant Borrower the amount of the refund or credit (and
interest with respect thereto) actually received.
(e) The Bank, Lending Office or Assignee shall use reasonable efforts
(consistent with its internal policies and legal and regulatory restrictions) to
change the jurisdiction of its relevant Lending Office if such change would
avoid or reduce any Withholding Tax; provided that no such change of
jurisdiction shall be made if, in the reasonable judgment of the Bank, such
Lending Office or such Assignee, such change would be disadvantageous to the
Bank, such Lending Office or such Assignee, as the case may be.
(f) The Bank or its Affiliate, Lending Office or Assignee agrees that it
will deliver to the Guarantor or the Borrowers, within 30 days after the
execution of this Agreement (unless theretofore so delivered) and as may be
reasonably required from time to time by applicable law or regulation, United
States Internal Revenue Service Forms W-8BEN and/or W-8ECI (or successor Forms)
or such other form, if any, as from time to time may permit the Guarantor or the
Borrowers to demonstrate that payments made by the Guarantor or the Borrowers to
the Bank or its Affiliate, Lending Office or Assignee under this Agreement
either are exempt from United States Federal Withholding Taxes or are payable at
a reduced rate (if any) specified in any applicable tax treaty or convention.
<PAGE>
4.02 ILLEGALITY.
----------
(a) If the Bank shall determine that the introduction of any Requirement of
Law, or any change in any Requirement of Law or in the interpretation
or administration thereof, has made it unlawful, or that any central
bank or other Governmental Authority has asserted that it is unlawful,
for the Bank or any other relevant Lending Office to make LIBO Rate
Loans or to issue Letters of Credit, then, on notice thereof by the
Bank to the Borrowers, the obligation of the Bank to make LIBO Rate
Loans or to issue Letters of Credit, as the case may be, shall be
suspended until the Bank shall have notified the Borrowers that the
circumstances giving rise to such determination no longer exist.
(b) If the Bank shall determine that it is unlawful to maintain any LIBO
Rate Loan, the affected Borrowers shall prepay in full all LIBO Rate
Loans then outstanding, together with interest accrued thereon, either
on the last day of the Interest Period thereof if the Bank may lawfully
continue to maintain such LIBO Rate Loans to such day, or immediately,
if the Bank may not lawfully continue to maintain such LIBO Rate Loans,
together with any amounts required to be paid in connection therewith
pursuant to Section 4.04.
(c) The Bank shall immediately notify the Borrowers of any event described
in (a) or (b) above.
4.03 INCREASED COSTS AND REDUCTION OF RETURN; ADDITIONAL INTEREST ON LIBO
RATE LOANS.
(a) If the Bank shall determine that, due to either (i) the introduction of
any Requirement of Law, or any change in any Requirement of Law or in the
interpretation or administration thereof or (ii) the compliance with any
guideline or request from any central bank or other Governmental Authority
(whether or not having the force of law), there shall be any increase in the
cost to the Bank or any Lending Office of agreeing to make or making, funding or
maintaining any LIBO Rate Loans, then the relevant Borrowers shall be liable
for, and shall from time to time, upon written request therefor by the Bank, pay
to the Bank additional amounts as are sufficient to compensate the Bank or such
Lending Office for such increased costs.
(b) If the Bank shall have determined that (i) the introduction of any
Capital Adequacy Regulation, (ii) any change in any Capital Adequacy Regulation,
(iii) any change in the interpretation or administration of any Capital Adequacy
Regulation by any central bank or other Governmental Authority charged with the
interpretation or administration thereof, or (iv) compliance by the Bank (or
other relevant Lending Office) or any corporation controlling the Bank, with any
Capital Adequacy Regulation affects or would affect the amount of capital
required or expected to be maintained by the Bank, any Lending Office or any
corporation controlling the Bank and (taking into consideration the Bank's and
such controlling corporation's policies with respect to capital adequacy and the
Bank's desired return on capital) and determines that the amount of such capital
is increased as a consequence of Advances under this Agreement, then, upon
written request of the Bank, the Borrowers shall immediately pay to the Bank or
the relevant Lending Office, from time to time as specified by the Bank,
additional amounts sufficient to compensate the Bank or such Lending Office for
such increase.
<PAGE>
(c) Each Borrower shall pay to the Bank, as long as the Bank shall be
required under Federal Reserve Board regulations to maintain reserves with
respect to liabilities or assets consisting of or including Eurocurrency funds
or deposits (currently known as "Eurocurrency liabilities"), additional costs on
the unpaid principal amount of all LIBO Rate Loans made by the Bank to such
Borrower equal to the actual costs of such reserves allocated to each such Loan
by the Bank (as determined by the Bank in good faith, which determination shall
be conclusive absent manifest error), payable on each Interest Payment Date with
respect to each such Loan, provided that such Borrower shall have received at
least 15 days' prior -------- written notice of such additional costs from the
Bank. If the Bank fails to give notice 15 days prior to the relevant Interest
Payment Date, such additional interest shall accrue and be payable 15 days from
receipt of such notice.
(d) The Bank will notify each Borrower of any event occurring after the
date hereof which will entitle the Bank or any Lending Office to compensation
from such Borrower pursuant to this Section 4.03 as promptly as practicable
after it obtains knowledge thereof and determines to request such compensation,
and will designate a different Lending Office if such designation will avoid the
need for, or reduce the amount of, such compensation. If the Bank requests
compensation under this Section 4.03, the relevant Borrowers may, by notice to
the Bank, require that: (x) the Bank furnish to the relevant Borrowers a
statement setting forth the basis for requesting such compensation and the
method for determining the amount thereof or (y) the Loans of the type with
respect to which such compensation is requested be either prepaid or converted
into another type.
4.04 FUNDING LOSSES. Each Borrower agrees to reimburse the Bank and to hold
the Bank and any relevant Lending Office harmless from any loss or expense which
the Bank may sustain or incur as a consequence of:
(a) the failure by such Borrower to make any payment or prepayment of
principal of any LIBO Rate Loan when due (including payments made after
any acceleration thereof);
(b) the failure by such Borrower to borrow, continue or convert a Loan
after such Borrower has given (or is deemed to have given) a notice of
borrowing or a notice of conversion or continuation;
(c) the failure by such Borrower to make any prepayment after such
Borrower has given a notice in accordance with Section 2.05;
(d) the prepayment of a LIBO Rate Loan on a day which is not the last
day of the Interest Period with respect thereto; or
(e) the conversion pursuant to Section 2.03 of any LIBO Rate Loan to a Base
Rate Loan or Optional Rate Loan on a day that is not the last day of
the Interest Period with respect to the LIBO Rate Loan;
<PAGE>
including any such loss or expense arising from the liquidation or reemployment
of funds obtained by any Lending Office to maintain its LIBO Rate Loans
hereunder or from fees payable to terminate the deposits from which such funds
were obtained.
4.05 INABILITY TO DETERMINE RATES. If the Bank shall have determined that for
any reason adequate and reasonable means do not exist for ascertaining the LIBO
Rate for any requested Interest Period with respect to a LIBO Rate Loan or that
the LIBO Rate for any requested Interest Period with respect thereto does not
adequately and fairly reflect the cost to the Bank or any relevant Lending
Office of funding such Loan, the Bank will forthwith give notice of such
determination to the relevant Borrowers. Thereafter, the obligation of the Bank
or any relevant Lending Office to make or continue LIBO Rate Loans or to convert
Base Rate Loans or Optional Rate Loans to LIBO Rate Loans hereunder, as the case
may be, shall be suspended until the Bank revokes such notice in writing. Upon
receipt of such notice, the relevant Borrower may revoke any notice of borrowing
or notice of conversion or continuation then submitted by it. If the relevant
Borrower does not revoke such notice with respect to a LIBO Rate Loan, the Bank
shall make, convert or continue the Loan, as proposed by such Borrower, in the
amount specified in the applicable notice submitted by such Borrower, but such
Loan shall be made, converted or continued as a Base Rate Loan instead of a LIBO
Rate Loan.
4.06 CERTIFICATE OF THE BANK. If claiming reimbursement or compensation pursuant
to this Article IV, the Bank shall deliver to each relevant Borrower a
certificate setting forth in reasonable detail the amount payable to the Bank or
any relevant Lending Office hereunder, and such certificate shall be conclusive
and binding on each recipient Borrower in the absence of manifest error.
4.07 SURVIVAL. The agreements and obligations of the Borrowers in this
Article IV shall survive the payment of all other Obligations.
ARTICLE V
CONDITIONS PRECEDENT
5.01 CONDITIONS TO EFFECTIVENESS OF THIS AGREEMENT. The effectiveness of this
Agreement is subject to the condition that the Bank shall have received on or
before the Effective Date all of the following, in form and substance
satisfactory to the Bank and its counsel:
(a) Credit Agreement. This Agreement executed by each Borrower and by the
Guarantor;
(b) Resolutions; Incumbency.
-----------------------
(i) Copies of the resolutions of the board of directors of BAX,
Brink's and the Guarantor approving and authorizing the
execution, delivery and performance of this Agreement and the
other Loan Documents to be delivered by it hereunder, and, in
the case of BAX and Brink's, authorizing the borrowing of the
Loans and the incurrence of the Reimbursement Obligations,
certified as of the Effective Date by the Secretary or an
Assistant Secretary of such Borrower or the Guarantor, as the
case may be; and
<PAGE>
(ii) A certificate of the Secretary or Assistant Secretary of BAX,
Brink's and the Guarantor as of the Effective Date certifying
the names and true signatures of the officers of such Borrower
or the Guarantor, as the case may be, authorized to execute
and deliver this Agreement and all other Loan Documents to be
delivered by it hereunder.
(c) Articles of Incorporation, By-laws and Good Standing.
Each of the following documents:
(i) the articles or certificate of incorporation of BAX, Brink's
and the Guarantor as in effect on the Effective Date,
certified by the Secretary of State of its state of
incorporation as of a recent date and by its Secretary or
Assistant Secretary as of the Effective Date;
(ii) the by-laws of BAX, Brink's and the Guarantor as in effect on
the Effective Date, certified by the Secretary or Assistant
Secretary of such Borrower or the Guarantor, as the case may
be, as of the Effective Date; and
(iii) a good standing certificate for BAX, Brink's and the Guarantor
from the Secretary of State of its state of incorporation as
of a recent date.
(d) Guaranty. The Guaranty executed by the Guarantor.
(e) Notes. Any Notes requested by the Bank, executed by the applicable
Borrower.
(f) Legal Opinion. Opinions in form and substance reasonably
satisfactory to the Bank of an assistant general counsel of the
Guarantor (and in such capacity, acting as counsel to the
Borrowers) and of Hunton & Williams, counsel to the Guarantor and the
Borrowers.
(g) Payment of Costs and Fees. The Borrowers shall have paid (i) all costs,
accrued and unpaid fees and expenses incurred by the Bank, to the
extent due and payable on the Effective Date, including the fees and
expenses of outside counsel to the Bank, and (ii) the initial
arrangement fee of $35,000.
(h) Certificates. A certificate signed by a Responsible Officer of each
Borrower and the Guarantor, date as of the Effective Date, stating
that:
(i) the representations and warranties made by such Person in
Article VI, and the representations and warranties made by the
Guarantor in the Guaranty, are true and correct on and as of
such date, as though made on and as of such date;
(ii) no Default or Event of Default exists as of and after giving effect to
the Effective Date; and
(iii) since December 31, 2001, there has occurred no event or
circumstance that has had or would have a Material Adverse
Effect; and
(i) Financial Statements. A copy of the audited and unaudited financial
statements of the Guarantor and its Subsidiaries referred to in Section
6.07, accompanied by a copy of the related auditor's report, in the
case of the audited financial statements, and a certificate of a
Responsible Officer of the Guarantor, in the case of the unaudited
financial statements.
(j) No Legal Bar; Approvals. All governmental and third party approvals
necessary in connection with the financing contemplated hereby shall
have been obtained and be in full force and effect, and there shall not
exist any judgment, order, injunction or other restraint issued or
filed or a hearing seeking injunctive relief or other restraint pending
or notified prohibiting the transactions contemplated by this Agreement
and the other Loan Documents, or any pending or threatened litigation
seeking such a result.
5.02 CONDITIONS TO SUBSEQUENT ADVANCES. The obligation of the Bank to make
any Advance after the Effective Date is subject to the satisfaction of the
following conditions precedent on the date of the relevant extension of credit:
(a) Notice of Advance. The Bank shall have received a notice of borrowing
pursuant to Section 2.02 or an L/C Application pursuant to Section 3.03;
(b) Continuation of Representations and Warranties. The representations and
warranties made by the Borrowers and the Guarantor in Article VI and the
representations and warranties made by the Guarantor in the Guaranty shall be
true and correct on and as of the date of such extension of credit with the same
effect as if made on and as of such date;
(c) No Existing Default. No Default or Event of Default shall exist on the
date of such extension of credit or shall result from such extension of credit;
and
(d) Additional Documentation. The relevant Borrower shall have delivered
any Note or other document as the relevant Lending Office may reasonably
require.
Each request for an Advance shall constitute a representation and
warranty by the requesting Borrower that, as of the date of such request and as
of the date that the Advance is made, the conditions in this Section 5.02 are
satisfied.
<PAGE>
5.03 CONDITIONS FOR PARTICIPATION BY ADDITIONAL COVERED SUBSIDIARIES. The Bank's
acceptance of additional Covered Subsidiaries as parties to and Borrowers under
this Agreement after the Effective Date is subject to the satisfaction of the
following conditions precedent before the effectiveness of each such Covered
Subsidiary's Election to Participate:
(a) Election to Participate. The Bank shall have received an Election to
Participate from the Covered Subsidiary, duly executed by such Covered
Subsidiary, BAX (in the case of a BAX Covered Subsidiary) or Brink's
(in the case of a Brink's Covered Subsidiary) and the Guarantor, in the
form of Exhibit A hereto (in the case of a BAX Covered Subsidiary) or
Exhibit B hereto (in the case of a Brink's Covered Subsidiary);
(b) Authorization. The Bank shall have received evidence of the authority
for and the validity of the Election to Participate of such Covered
Subsidiary including, without limitation, documents of the type listed
in Sections 5.01(b) and (c) or similar constitutive documents, and any
other documents the Bank may reasonably request, all in form and
substance satisfactory to the Bank.
(c) Continuation of Representations and Warranties. The representations and
warranties made by the Borrowers and the Guarantor in Article VI and
the representations and warranties of the Guarantor made in the
Guaranty shall be true and correct on and as of the date of such
Election to Participate with the same effect as if made on and as of
such date.
(d) Bank Approval. The Bank, in its reasonable discretion, shall have
accepted such Covered Subsidiary as a Borrower hereunder by returning
an executed copy of its Election to Participate to such Covered
Subsidiary, BAX or Brink's, as the case may be, and the Guarantor.
(e) Indemnity and Waiver. Notwithstanding the requirements of clause (b) of
this Section 5.03, BAX or Brink's may request that the Bank temporarily waive
the requirements of such clause (b) by executing and delivering to the Bank an
Indemnity and Waiver Request in the form of Exhibit D-1 hereto (in the case of a
BAX Covered Subsidiary) or Exhibit D-2 hereto (in the case of a Brink's Covered
Subsidiary). If such an Indemnity and Waiver Request is accepted by the Bank,
then the Covered Subsidiary to which it refers may become a party to and
Borrower under this Agreement notwithstanding its failure to meet the condition
set forth in Section 5.03(b); provided, however, that such Covered Subsidiary
must subsequently satisfy the requirements of Section 5.03(b). If (1) the
condition set forth in Section 5.03(b) has not been satisfied within 75 days
after such Covered Subsidiary has become a party to andBorrower under the
Agreement, and (2) the Bank shall have given the Guarantor and either BAX (in
the case of a BAX Covered Subsidiary) or Brink's (in the case of a Brink's
Covered Subsidiary) 15 days' written notice of such failure and it shall
nevertheless continue and (3) the proposed Covered Subsidiary together with BAX
or Brink's, as the case may be, shall not have notified the Bank of their
respective decisions that such Subsidiary shall not become a Covered Subsidiary
hereunder, then all amounts owed to the Bank by the proposed Covered Subsidiary
hereunder, under any promissory note or any other loan document shall, at the
option of the Bank and upon written notice from the Bank to BAX or Brink's (as
the case may be) and to the Guarantor, become immediately due and payable and
such proposed Covered Subsidiary shall not thereafter be a Covered Subsidiary
hereunder, unless and until such proposed covered Subsidiary shall have
satisfied fully the requirements of this Section 5.03.
<PAGE>
ARTICLE VI
REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES
Each Borrower, and, to the extent set forth below, the Guarantor,
represents and warrants to the Bank, for its benefit and for the benefit of all
Lending Offices, as follows:
6.01 CORPORATE EXISTENCE. Such Borrower is duly organized, validly existing and
in good standing under the laws of its jurisdiction of incorporation and (i) has
the requisite power and authority to own its property and assets and to carry on
its business as now conducted and (ii) is qualified to do business in every
jurisdiction where such qualification is required, except where the failure so
to qualify would not have a Material Adverse Effect. Such Borrower has the
corporate power to execute and deliver and to perform its obligations under the
Loan Documents to which it is party and to borrow hereunder.
6.02 NON-CONTRAVENTION. The execution, delivery and performance by such Borrower
of the Loan Documents to which it is party have been duly authorized by all
necessary corporate action and do not and will not (i) require any consent or
approval of the shareholders of the Borrower, (ii) violate any provision of any
law, rule, regulation (including, without limitation, Regulation T, U or X of
the Federal Reserve Board), order, writ, judgment, injunction, decree,
determination, or award presently in effect having applicability to the Borrower
or of the charter or by-laws of the Borrower, (iii) result in a material breach
of or constitute a material default under any indenture or loan or credit
agreement or any other agreement, lease, or instrument to which such Borrower is
a party or by which it or its properties may be bound or affected, or (iv)
result in the creation of an Encumbrance of any nature upon or with respect to
any of the properties now owned or hereafter acquired by such Borrower; and such
Borrower is not in default under any such order, writ, judgment, injunction,
decree, determination, or award or any such indenture, agreement, lease, or
instrument or in default under any such law, rule, or regulation, which default
would have a Material Adverse Effect.
6.03 NO CONSENT. No authorization, consent, approval, license, exemption of, or
filing or registration with, or any other action in respect of any Governmental
Authority is or will be necessary for the valid execution, delivery or
performance by such Borrower of the Loan Documents to which it is party.
6.04 BINDING OBLIGATIONS. Each of the Loan Documents to which such Borrower is
party constitute legal, valid, and binding obligations of such Borrower
enforceable against such Borrower in accordance with their respective terms,
except as enforceability may be limited by applicable bankruptcy, insolvency or
similar laws affecting the enforcement of creditors' rights generally or by
equitable principles relating to enforceability.
6.05 TITLE TO PROPERTIES. Such Borrower has good and marketable title to all of
the material assets and properties purported to be owned by it, free and clear
of all liens except those liens permitted by the Guarantor Credit Agreement.
6.06 SUBSIDIARIES. Each BAX Covered Subsidiary is a Subsidiary of BAX, each
Brink's Covered Subsidiary is a Subsidiary of Brink's, and all of such Covered
Subsidiaries' shares which are owned, directly or indirectly, by BAX or Brink's
have been duly authorized and validly issued, are fully paid and nonassessable
and are free and clear of any Encumbrance. The Guarantor represents and warrants
that Pittston Minerals Group Inc., a Virginia corporation, and its Subsidiaries,
Pittston Coal Company, a Virginia corporation, and Pittston Mineral Ventures
Company, a Delaware corporation, and their respective Subsidiaries, are not
direct or indirect Subsidiaries of BAX or Brink's and may not at any time become
Covered Subsidiaries.
<PAGE>
6.07 FINANCIAL STATEMENTS. The Guarantor hereby represents and warrants
that:
(a) The consolidated balance sheet of the Guarantor and its Subsidiaries as
at December 31, 2001, and the related consolidated statements of operations,
shareholders' equity and cash flows for the year then ended, certified by KPMG
LLP, independent public accountants, copies of which will be delivered to the
Bank on or prior to the Effective Date, fairly present in all material respects
the consolidated financial condition of the Guarantor and its Subsidiaries as at
such date and the consolidated results of their operations for the year then
ended, all prepared in accordance with GAAP applied on a consistent basis.
(b) The unaudited consolidated balance sheet of the Guarantor and its
Subsidiaries as at June 30, 2002, the related unaudited consolidated statement
of operations of the Guarantor and its Subsidiaries for the fiscal quarter year
then ended, and the related unaudited consolidated statement of cash flows of
the Guarantor and its Subsidiaries for the fiscal quarter then ended, copies of
which will be delivered to the Bank on or prior to the Effective Date, fairly
present in all material respects the consolidated financial condition of the
Guarantor and its Subsidiaries as at such date and their consolidated results of
operations for the quarter then ended, all prepared in accordance with GAAP
(except for the omission of notes and subject to year-end adjustments) applied
on a consistent basis; and there has been no material adverse change in such
condition or operations since June 30, 2002 that has had a Material Adverse
Effect.
6.08 LITIGATION. Except as otherwise disclosed in writing to the Bank, including
through the delivery to the Bank of copies of reports and statements filed by
the Guarantor with the Securities and Exchange Commission, there are no actions,
suits, or proceedings pending or, to the knowledge of the Borrower, threatened
against or affecting the Borrower or the properties of such Borrower before any
Governmental Authority or arbitrator that would have a Material Adverse Effect,
and such Borrower is not in default (in any respect which would have a Material
Adverse Effect) with respect to any law, rule, regulation, order, writ,
judgment, injunction, decree, determination or award presently in effect and
applicable to such Borrower.
6.09 TAXES. Each Borrower and the Guarantor has filed all material tax returns
(federal, state, and local) required to be filed and paid all taxes shown
thereon to be due, including interest and penalties, or provided adequate
reserves, in accordance with GAAP, for the payment thereof.
6.10 ERISA. Each Plan has complied with and has been administered in all
material respects in accordance with the applicable provisions of ERISA and the
Code. No Plan has terminated under circumstances giving rise to liability of the
Borrower or any ERISA Affiliate to the PBGC under Section 4062, 4063 or 4064 of
ERISA, which liability remains unpaid in whole or in part, and no lien under
Section 4068 of ERISA exists with respect to the assets of the Borrower or any
ERISA Affiliate. No Reportable Event has occurred with respect to any Plan,
except for Reportable Events previously disclosed in writing to the Bank that
would not have a Material Adverse Effect. No accumulated funding deficiency
within the meaning of Section 302 of ERISA or Section 412 of the Code (whether
or not waived) exists with respect to any Plan, nor does any lien under Section
302 of ERISA or Section 412 of the Code exist with respect to any Plan.
<PAGE>
Neither such Borrower nor any ERISA Affiliate has completely or
partially withdrawn from any one or more Multiemployer Plans under circumstances
which would give rise to withdrawal liability which, in the aggregate, could
have a Material Adverse Effect and which has not been fully paid as of the date
hereof. Neither the Borrower nor any ERISA Affiliate has received notice that
any Multiemployer Plan is in reorganization (within the meaning of Section 4241
of ERISA), is insolvent (within the meaning of Section 4245 of ERISA), or has
terminated under Title IV of ERISA, nor, to the best knowledge of the Borrower,
is any such reorganization, insolvency or termination reasonably likely to
occur, where such reorganization, insolvency or termination has resulted or can
reasonably be expected to result in an increase in the contributions required to
be made to such Multiemployer Plan in an amount that would have a Material
Adverse Effect. Neither the Borrower nor any ERISA Affiliate has failed to make
any contribution to a Multiemployer Plan which is required under ERISA or an
applicable collective bargaining agreement in an amount which is material in the
aggregate (except to the extent there is a good faith dispute as to whether any
contribution is owed, the amount owed or the existence of facts that would give
rise to a withdrawal).
6.11 NO DEFAULT. Each Borrower and the Guarantor represent and warrant that
no Default and no Event of Default has occurred and is continuing.
6.12 FEDERAL RESERVE REGULATIONS.
---------------------------
(a) The Borrower is not engaged principally, or as one of its important
activities, in the business of extending credit for the purpose of
purchasing or carrying Margin Stock.
(b) No part of the proceeds of any Advances will be used, whether directly
or indirectly, and whether immediately, incidentally or ultimately, for
any purpose which entails a violation of, or which is inconsistent
with, the provisions of the Regulations promulgated by the Federal
Reserve Board, including, without limitation, Regulations T, U or X.
6.13 INVESTMENT COMPANY ACT. None of the Borrowers nor the Guarantor is an
"investment company" as defined in, or subject to regulation under, the
Investment Company Act of 1940.
<PAGE>
6.14 ENVIRONMENTAL MATTERS. In the ordinary course of its business, the
Guarantor conducts an ongoing review of the effect of Environmental Laws and
laws relating to occupational safety and health on the business, operations and
properties of the Guarantor and its Subsidiaries, in the course of which it
identifies and evaluates associated liabilities and costs (including any capital
or operating expenditures required for clean-up, closure or restoration of
properties presently or previously owned, any capital or operating expenditures
required to achieve or maintain compliance with environmental protection and
occupational health and safety standards imposed by law or as a condition of any
license, permit or contact, any related constraints on operating activities,
including any periodic or permanent shutdown of any facility or reduction in the
level of or change in the nature of operations conducted thereat and any actual
or potential liabilities to third parties, including employees, and any related
costs and expenses). On the basis of this review, each Borrower and the
Guarantor represents and warrants that applicable Environmental Laws and laws
relating to occupational health and safety do not have a Material Adverse
Effect, and it has obtained and holds all material permits, licenses and
approvals required under Environmental Laws which are necessary for the conduct
of its business and the operation of its facilities, and it has not received any
written notice of any failure to be in compliance with the terms and conditions
of such permits, licenses and approvals, which failure could reasonably be
expected to have a Material Adverse Effect.
6.15 PRIORITY OF DEBT. Each Borrower and the Guarantor hereby represents and
warrants that all Debt created under this Agreement for which it is or may be
liable ranks pari passu with the Debt outstanding under the Guarantor Credit
Agreement.
6.16 ACCURACY AND COMPLETENESS OF INFORMATION. The financial statements
referenced in Section 6.07, the financial statements to be provided pursuant to
Section 7.04 and the written information with respect to the Guarantor and the
Borrowers contained in this Agreement, taken as a whole, do not contain any
material misstatement of fact or omit to state any material fact necessary to
make the statements therein, in light of the circumstances under which such
statements were then made, not misleading.
ARTICLE VII
COVENANTS
7.01 POST-EFFECTIVE DATE TRANSACTIONS. Within 60 days after the Effective Date
each BAX Covered Subsidiary that is a Borrower hereunder as of the Effective
Date, each Brink's Covered Subsidiary that is a Borrower hereunder as of the
Effective Date, and each other Covered Subsidiary that may be a Borrower
hereunder when such documents are delivered, shall furnish to the Bank documents
of the type listed in Sections 5.01(b) and (c) or similar constitutive
documents. Each such Brink's Covered Subsidiary is a Subsidiary of both Brink's
and the Guarantor, and Brink's and the Guarantor each represent and warrant to
the Bank that each of the Representations and Warranties contained in Article VI
which would, by their terms, apply to a Covered Subsidiary are true and correct
with respect to such Brink's Covered Subsidiaries. In addition, the Company and
the Guarantor hereby jointly and severally agree to indemnify the Bank and hold
it harmless from any loss, cost or expense which may arise from: (i) agreeing to
the provisions of this Section 7.01 and (ii) extending credit to such Brink's
Covered Subsidiaries during such 60-day period. In addition (and without
limitation) during such 60-day period, the Guaranty shall secure the obligations
of such Brink's Covered Subsidiaries just as if the requirements of Section
5.03(b) had been fully satisfied.
1
<PAGE>
7.02 AFFIRMATIVE COVENANTS. For the benefit of the Bank and all Lending Offices,
so long as any Advance remains outstanding hereunder or the Commitment remains
in effect, each Borrower and the Guarantor shall, unless the Bank otherwise
consents in writing:
(i) Payment of Taxes, etc. Pay and discharge all taxes,
assessments and governmental charges or levies imposed upon it
or upon its income or profits, or upon any properties
belonging to it, prior to the date on which penalties attach
thereto, and all lawful claims which, if unpaid, might become
a lien or charge upon any of its properties; provided,
however, that neither it shall not be required to pay any such
tax, assessment, charge, levy or claim which is being
contested in good faith and by proper proceedings and against
which it is maintaining adequate reserves in accordance with
GAAP.
(ii) Maintenance of Insurance. Maintain, and cause each Restricted
Subsidiary to maintain, insurance with responsible and
reputable insurance companies or associations (or, to the
extent consistent with prudent business practice, through its
own program of self-insurance) in such amounts and covering
such risks as is usually carried by companies engaged in
similar businesses and owning similar properties in the same
general areas in which it operates.
(iii) Preservation of Corporate Existence, etc. Preserve and
maintain its corporate existence, rights, franchises and
privileges in the jurisdiction of its incorporation; provided,
however, that nothing herein contained shall prevent any
merger or consolidation permitted by Section 7.03(ii).
(iv) Compliance with Laws, etc. Comply with the requirements of all
applicable laws, rules, regulations and orders (other than
laws, rules, regulations, and orders which are not final and
are being contested in good faith by proper proceedings) of
any Governmental Authority (including Labor Laws and
Environmental Laws) applicable to or binding upon it or its
property, noncompliance with which would have a Material
Adverse Effect.
(v) Compliance with ERISA. Comply with the minimum funding
standards under ERISA with respect to its Plans and use its
best efforts to comply in all material respects with all other
applicable provisions of ERISA and the regulations and
interpretations promulgated thereunder.
(vi) Access to Properties. Permit any representatives designated by
the Bank, upon reasonable prior notice to it, to visit its
properties at reasonable times and as often as reasonably
requested.
(vii) Use of Proceeds. Use the Advances, and any proceeds thereof,
for working capital and other general corporate purposes not
in contravention of any Requirement of Law or the provisions
of Section 6.12(b).
7.03 NEGATIVE COVENANTS. For the benefit of the Bank and all Lending Offices, so
long as any Advance remains outstanding hereunder or the Commitment remains in
effect, none of the Borrowers nor the Guarantor will suffer or permit to any of
the following to exist, unless the Bank otherwise consents in writing:
2
<PAGE>
(i) Debt Encumbrances. Have any Debt for borrowed money secured by an
Encumbrance on any property of any Borrower or the Guarantor, unless (a) such
Borrower's payment obligations hereunder, or the Guarantor's payment obligations
under the Guaranty, as the case may be, shall have effectively been secured
equally and ratably with (or, at the option of such Borrower or the Guarantor,
as the case may be, in priority to) such secured Debt or (b) immediately after
giving effect thereto and to any concurrent repayment of Debt, the aggregate
amount of all such secured Debt of the Guarantor and of each of its Restricted
Subsidiaries, plus the aggregate amount of Consolidated Lease Rentals (excluding
Consolidated Lease Rentals under Leases in effect as of December 31, 2001, and
any renewal, extension or replacement thereof, and Leases with respect to
property not owned by the Guarantor on such date), discounted to present value
at 10%, compounded annually, arising out of all Sale and Leaseback Transactions
to which the Guarantor or any of its Restricted Subsidiaries is then a party,
does not exceed 10% of Consolidated Net Worth; provided, however, that this
Section 7.03(i) shall not apply to, and there shall be excluded from secured
Debt in any computation under this Section 7.03(i), Debt secured by
(A) Encumbrances existing on the Closing Date and set forth on Schedule
7.03(i);
(B) Encumbrances for taxes, assessments and other governmental charges or
levies not yet due or as to which the period of grace, if any, related thereto
has not expired or which are being contested in good faith and by appropriate
proceedings if adequate reserves are maintained to the extent required by GAAP;
(C) The claims of materialmen, mechanics, carriers, warehousemen,
processors or landlords for labor, materials, supplies or rentals incurred in
the ordinary course of business, (i) which are not overdue for a period of more
than 30 days or (ii) which are being contested in good faith and by appropriate
proceedings if adequate reserves are maintained to the extent required by GAAP;
(D) Encumbrances consisting of deposits or pledges made in the ordinary
course of business (i) in connection with, or to secure payment of, obligations
under workers' compensation, unemployment insurance or similar legislation or
obligations under customer service contracts, or (ii) to secure (or to obtain
letters of credit that secure) the performance of tenders, statutory
obligations, surety bonds, appeal bonds, bids, leases (other than Capital
Leases), performance bonds, purchase, construction or sales contracts and other
similar obligations, in each case not incurred or made in connection with the
borrowing of money, the obtaining of advances or credit or the payment of the
deferred purchase price of property;
<PAGE>
(E) Encumbrances constituting encumbrances in the nature of zoning
restrictions, easements and rights or restrictions of record on the use of real
property, which in the aggregate are not substantial in amount and which do not,
in any case, detract from the value of any material parcel of real property or
impair the use thereof in the ordinary conduct of business;
(F) Encumbrances in favor of the Bank;
(G) Encumbrances on the property or assets of any Restricted Subsidiary
existing at the time such Restricted Subsidiary becomes a Subsidiary of the
Guarantor and not incurred in contemplation thereof, as long as the outstanding
principal amount of the Debt secured thereby is not voluntarily increased by
such Restricted Subsidiary after the date such Restricted Subsidiary becomes a
Subsidiary of the
Guarantor;
(H) Encumbrances on the property or assets of the Borrowers or the
Guarantor or any Restricted Subsidiary securing Debt which is incurred to
finance the acquisition of such property or assets, provided that (i) each such
Encumbrance shall be created simultaneously with, or within twelve months after,
the acquisition of the related property or assets; (ii) each such Encumbrance
does not at any time encumber any property other than the related property or
assets financed by such Debt; (iii) the principal amount of Debt secured by each
such Encumbrance is not increased; and (iv) the principal amount of Debt secured
by each such Encumbrance shall at no time exceed 100% of the original purchase
price of such related property or assets at the time acquired;
(I) Encumbrances consisting of judgment or judicial attachment
Encumbrances, provided that (i) the claims giving rise to such Encumbrances are
being diligently contested in good faith by appropriate proceedings, (ii)
adequate reserves for the obligations secured by such Encumbrances have been
established and (iii) enforcement of such Encumbrances has been stayed;
(J) Encumbrances created or deemed to exist in connection with any asset
securitization program (including any related filings of any financing
statements), but only to the extent that such Encumbrances attach to the assets
actually sold, contributed, financed or otherwise conveyed or pledged in
connection with such securitization program;
(K) Encumbrances on property or assets of the Borrowers or the Guarantor or
any Restricted Subsidiary securing indebtedness owing to the Borrowers or the
Guarantor;
<PAGE>
(L) Encumbrances on coal reserves leased by the Guarantor or by any
Restricted Subsidiary as lessee, securing Debt to the lessors thereof, arising
out of such leases;
(M) Encumbrances on any Margin Stock purchased or carried by the Guarantor
or any of its Subsidiaries; and
(N) The extension, renewal or replacement of any Encumbrance permitted by
clauses (A), (G), (H) or (L), but only if the principal amount of Debt secured
by the Encumbrance immediately prior thereto is not increased and the
Encumbrance is not extended to other property.
For purposes of this Section 7.03(i), property of a corporation when it
becomes a successor or transferee of the Guarantor or a Restricted Subsidiary
shall be deemed to have been acquired at that time and any Encumbrance existing
on property when acquired shall be deemed to have been created at that time. The
sale or transfer of (A) coal, oil, gas or other minerals in place for a period
of time until, or in an amount such that, the transferee will realize therefrom
a specified amount of money (however determined) or a specified amount of such
coal or other minerals or (B) any other interest in property of the character
commonly referred to as a "production payment" shall not be deemed to constitute
Debt secured by an Encumbrance. In the event that any Borrower shall hereafter
be required to secure its payment obligations hereunder, or the Guarantor shall
hereafter be required to secure its payment obligations under the Guaranty,
equally and ratably with any other Debt pursuant to this Section 7.03(i), then
(X) such Borrower, or the Guarantor, as the case may be, will promptly deliver
to the Bank a certificate of its Responsible Officer stating that the provisions
of this Section 7.03(i) have been complied with and an opinion of counsel
satisfactory to the Bank to the effect that the provisions of this Section
7.03(i) have been complied with and all instruments executed by such Person in
the performance of the requirements of this Section 7.03(i) comply with such
requirements and have been duly executed and delivered and are valid, binding
and enforceable and (Y) the Borrowers and the Guarantor shall enter into an
agreement supplemental hereto, and the Guarantor shall enter into an agreement
supplemental to the Guaranty, and the Borrowers and the Guarantor shall take
such other reasonable action, if any, as the Bank deems advisable, to enable the
Bank, as so secured, to enforce its rights hereunder and under the Guaranty.
(ii) Disposition of Debt and Shares of Restricted Subsidiaries; Issuance of
Shares by Restricted Subsidiaries; Consolidation, Merger or Disposition of
Assets. None of the Borrowers nor the Guarantor will (a) sell or otherwise
dispose of any shares or any Long Term Debt of any Restricted Subsidiary, other
than the sale of Capital Stock of the Pittston Minerals Group, Inc., and any of
its Subsidiaries, (b) in the case of any Restricted Subsidiary, issue, sell or
otherwise dispose of any of such Restricted Subsidiary's shares (other than
directors' qualifying shares, to satisfy preemptive rights or in connection with
a split or combination of shares or a dividend in shares) except to the
Guarantor or another Restricted Subsidiary or (c) directly or indirectly,
consolidate with or merge with or into or sell, lease or otherwise dispose of
all or substantially all of its assets (other than in the ordinary course of
business and the sale of all or any part of the assets of the Pittston Minerals
Group, Inc., and any of its Subsidiaries) to any Person unless, after giving
effect thereto, all of the following conditions shall be met:
<PAGE>
(w) the Leverage Ratio shall not be greater than 0.55:1.00;
(x) in the case of a consolidation or merger of the Guarantor, the
Guarantor shall be the surviving corporation, and, in the case of a sale or
other disposition of the Guarantor's assets as an entirety or substantially as
an entirety to any corporation, the successor or surviving corporation shall be
a solvent corporation organized under the laws of a state of the United States
of America which expressly assumes in writing the due and punctual payment and
performance of the obligations of the Guarantor under the Guaranty;
(y) if any properties or assets of the Guarantor or a Restricted Subsidiary
would thereupon become subject to an Encumbrance other than those described in
Section 7.03(i)(A) through (N), inclusive, the obligations of the Guarantor
under the Guaranty hereunder shall have been equally and ratably secured with
(or, at the option of the Guarantor, in priority to) any Debt secured by the
Encumbrance on such properties and assets, and the last paragraph of Section
7.03(i) shall be applicable thereto; and
(z) no Default or Event of Default has occurred and is continuing.
Provided that the conditions of this Section 7.03(ii) are met, none of the
foregoing shall be deemed to prohibit the Guarantor and/or its Subsidiaries from
selling, transferring, assigning or otherwise disposing of Margin Stock for fair
market value or selling, contributing, financing or otherwise conveying or
pledging assets in connection with any asset securitization program permitted by
Section 7.03(i)(J).
(iii) Transactions with Affiliates. Engage in any transaction with any
Person that any Borrower or the Guarantor Controls, is Controlled by or is under
common Control with (other than a Borrower, the Guarantor or a Restricted
Subsidiary) material to any Borrower or the Guarantor on terms more favorable to
such affiliated Person than would have been obtainable in arm's-length dealing.
<PAGE>
(iv) Interest Coverage Ratio. Permit the Interest Coverage Ratio for each
fiscal quarter of the Guarantor, to be calculated as at the end of such quarter,
to be less than 3.00:1.00.
(v) Leverage Ratio. Permit the Leverage Ratio as of the last day of each
fiscal quarter of the Guarantor to be greater than 0.55:1.00.
(vi) Compliance with Regulations T, U and X. Purchase or carry any Margin
Stock or incur, create or assume any obligation for borrowed money or other
liability or make any investment, capital contribution, loan, advance or
extension of credit or sell or otherwise dispose of any assets or pay any
dividend or make any other distribution to its shareholders or take or permit to
be taken any other action or permit to occur or exist any event or condition if
such action, event or condition would result in this Agreement, the Advances,
the use of the proceeds thereof or the other transactions contemplated hereby
violating or being inconsistent with Regulations T, U or X promulgated by the
Federal Reserve Board, including, Section 221.3(f) of said Regulation U.
(vii) Hedging Agreements. Enter into material Hedging Agreements for the
purpose of speculation and not for the purpose of hedging risks associated with
the businesses of the Guarantor, the Borrowers and the Guarantor's other
Subsidiaries.
(viii) ERISA.
(A) Terminate any Plan under circumstances which would
reasonably result in a material liability of the
Guarantor, any Borrower or any ERISA Affiliate to the
PBGC, or permit to exist the occurrence of any
Reportable Event or any other event or condition
which presents a material risk of such a termination
by the PBGC;
(B) engage, or permit any Plan to engage, in a
"prohibited transaction" (within the meaning of
Section 406 of ERISA or Section 4975 of the Code)
that would reasonably result in material liability of
the Guarantor, any Borrower or any of the Guarantor's
other Restricted Subsidiaries;
(C) fail to make any contribution to a Multiemployer Plan
which is required by ERISA or an applicable
collective bargaining agreement in an amount which is
material (except to the extent there is a good faith
dispute as to whether any contribution is owed, the
amount owed or the existence of facts that would give
rise to a withdrawal);
(D) completely or partially withdraw from a Multiemployer
Plan, if such complete or partial withdrawal would
result in any material withdrawal liability under
Title IV of ERISA; or
<PAGE>
(E) enter into any new Plan or modify any existing Plan
so as to increase its obligations thereunder which
could result in any material liability to the
Guarantor or any ERISA Affiliate.
For purposes of this Section 7.03(viii), an amount is material
if it would have a Material Adverse Effect, and the
materiality of any amount described in this Section 7.03(viii)
shall be determined after aggregation with all other
liabilities described in this Section 7.03(viii).
7.04 REPORTING REQUIREMENTS OF THE GUARANTOR. For the benefit of the Bank and
all Lending Offices, so long as any Advance remains outstanding hereunder or the
Commitment remains in effect, the Guarantor will, unless the Bank otherwise
consents in writing:
(i) furnish to the Bank:
(1) annually, as soon as available, but in any event within 120 days after
the last day of each of the Guarantor's fiscal years, consolidated balance
sheets of the Guarantor and its Subsidiaries as at the last day of such fiscal
year, and the related consolidated statements of operations, shareholders'
equity and cash flows for the fiscal year then ended, each prepared in
accordance with GAAP, in reasonable detail, and each setting forth in
comparative form corresponding figures from the preceding annual financial
statements, certified by independent certified public accountants of recognized
national standing as fairly presenting in all material respects the consolidated
financial condition and results of operations for the subject companies and
whose opinion shall not be qualified with respect to scope limitations imposed
by the Guarantor or any Subsidiary, the status of the Guarantor and its
Subsidiaries as a going concern or the accounting principles followed by the
Guarantor or any Subsidiary not in accordance with GAAP;
(2) as soon as available, but in any event within 60 days after the end of
each of the first three fiscal quarters of each of the Guarantor's fiscal years,
consolidated balance sheets as at the last day of such quarter and the related
consolidated statements of operations and cash flows for the quarter then ended,
and for the then-current fiscal year through the end of such quarter, for the
Guarantor and its Subsidiaries, in each case prepared in accordance with GAAP
(except for omission of notes and subject to year-end adjustments) and setting
forth in comparative form figures for the corresponding period in the prior
fiscal year, certified by a Responsible Officer of the Guarantor as fairly
presenting in all material respects the consolidated financial condition and
results of operations for the subject companies;
<PAGE>
(3) at the same time as it delivers the financial statements required under
the provisions of clause (1) above, a certificate signed by a Responsible
Officer of the Guarantor to the effect that such Officer has made due inquiry
and that to the best of the knowledge of such Officer except as stated therein
no Default or Event of Default has occurred hereunder and that such officer has
made due inquiry and that to the best of the knowledge of such Officer except as
stated therein no default has occurred under any other agreement to which the
Guarantor or any Borrower is a party or by which it is bound, or by which any of
its properties or assets may be affected, which could have a Material Adverse
Effect and specifying in reasonable detail the exceptions, if any, to such
statements;
(4) at the same time as it delivers the financial statements required under
the provisions of clauses (1) and (2) above, a statement of a Responsible
Officer of the Guarantor showing the Leverage Ratio and Interest Coverage Ratio
as of the last day of the fiscal period to which such financial statements
relate;
(5) at the same time as it delivers the financial statements required under
the provisions of clause (2) above, a certificate signed by a Responsible
Officer of the Guarantor and stating that such Officer has made due inquiry and
that to the best of his knowledge no Default has occurred and is continuing, or,
if such Default has occurred and is continuing, specify the nature and extent
thereof; and
(6) forthwith upon the occurrence of any Default or Event of Default, a
certificate of a Responsible Officer of the Guarantor setting forth the details
thereof and the action which the Guarantor or the Borrower, as the case may be,
is taking or proposes to take with respect thereto;
(ii) furnish to the Bank, promptly after the same are available,
copies of all current reports on Form 8-K, quarterly reports
on Form 10-Q, annual reports on Form 10-K (or similar
corresponding reports) and registration statements or
statements which the Guarantor or any Restricted Subsidiary
may be required to file with the Securities and Exchange
Commission (excluding registration statements filed pursuant
to employee stock option or benefit plans);
(iii) furnish to the Bank, as soon as reasonably practicable after
receipt by the Guarantor or any of its Subsidiaries, a copy of
any written notice or claim to the effect that the Guarantor
or any of its Subsidiaries is liable to any Person as a result
of the presence or release of any Contaminant which claim
could reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse
Effect; and
(iv) within three (3) Business Days after the Guarantor receives
notice of any change in the Applicable LT Rating, furnish
written notice of such change and the new Applicable LT Rating
to the Bank.
<PAGE>
7.05 ADDITIONAL REQUIREMENTS OF THE GUARANTOR AND THE BORROWERS. For the benefit
of the Bank and all Lending Offices, so long as any Advance remains outstanding
hereunder or the Commitment remains in effect, the Guarantor and each Borrower
will, unless the Bank otherwise consents in writing:
(i) keep proper books of record and accounts in which full, true
and correct entries in accordance with GAAP shall be made of
all dealings or transactions in relation to its business and
activities; and
(ii) furnish with reasonable promptness such other financial
information as the Bank may reasonably request, provided that
no Borrower, nor the Guarantor, shall be required to furnish
any information that would result in violation of any
confidentiality agreement by which it is bound but, at the
request of the Bank, shall use its reasonable best efforts to
obtain a waiver of such agreement to permit furnishing of such
information under this provision.
ARTICLE VIII
EVENTS OF DEFAULT
8.0 EVENT OF DEFAULT. Any of the following shall constitute an .
"Event of Default":
(a) Non-Payment. Any Borrower fails to pay (i) when and as required to be
paid herein, any amount of principal of any Loan or any Reimbursement
Obligation, or (ii) within three (3) business days after the same shall become
due, any interest, fee or any other amount payable hereunder or pursuant to any
other Loan Document to which such Borrower is a party;
(b) Breach of Representation or Warranty. Any representation or warranty by
any Borrower or the Guarantor made or deemed made herein or in any other Loan
Document, or which is contained in any certificate, document or financial or
other statement by any Borrower or the Guarantor, or their respective
Responsible Officers, furnished at any time under this Agreement, or in or under
any other Loan Document, shall prove to have been incorrect in any material
respect on or as of the date made or deemed made; provided that if the
representation or warranty contained in Section 6.16 or any representation
or warranty contained in any financial statement furnished under
this Agreement shall prove to be incorrect in any material respect on or as of
the date when made, such breach shall not constitute a Default or Event of
Default unless the Guarantor fails to correct such default (including without
limitation publicly correcting any related material misstatement of fact or
disclosing any material omitted fact) within 90 days after a Responsible Officer
obtains actual knowledge of such default;
<PAGE>
(c) Default in Performance of Certain Covenants. Any Borrower or Guarantor
fails to perform or observe any covenant or agreement contained in Section
7.03(iv), (v) or (vi), and such default shall continue unremedied for a period
of 10 days after the earlier of (i) the date upon which a Responsible Officer of
such Borrower or the Guarantor gives written notice of such failure to the Bank
or (ii) the date upon which written notice thereof is given to such Borrower or
the Guarantor by the Bank;
(d) Other Defaults. Any Borrower or the Guarantor fails to perform or
observe any other term or covenant contained in this Agreement or any other Loan
Document, and such default shall continue unremedied for a period of 30 days
after the earlier of (i) the date upon which a Responsible Officer of such
Borrower or the Guarantor gives written notice of such failure to the Bank or
(ii) the date upon which written notice thereof is given to such Borrower or the
Guarantor by the Bank;
(e) Insolvency; Voluntary Proceedings. The Guarantor or any Borrower (i)
ceases or fails to be solvent, or generally fails to pay, or admits in writing
its inability to pay, its debts as they become due, subject to applicable grace
periods, if any, whether at stated maturity or otherwise; (ii) voluntarily
ceases operations as a going concern; (iii) commences any Insolvency Proceeding
with respect to itself; or (iv) takes any action to effectuate or authorize any
of the foregoing;
(f) Involuntary Proceedings.
(i) Any involuntary Insolvency Proceeding is commenced or filed against the
Guarantor or any Borrower, or any writ, judgment, warrant of attachment,
execution or similar process, is issued or levied against a substantial part of
the property of the Guarantor, any Borrower or any of their respective
Subsidiaries, and any such proceeding or petition shall not be dismissed, or
such writ, judgment, warrant of attachment, execution or similar process shall
not be released, vacated or fully bonded within 60 days after commencement,
filing or levy;
(ii) the Guarantor, any Borrower or any of their respective Subsidiaries
admits the material allegations of a petition against it in any Insolvency
Proceeding, or an order for relief (or similar order under the laws of any
jurisdiction other than the United States of America or a political subdivision
thereof) is ordered in any Insolvency Proceeding; or
(iii) the Guarantor, any Borrower or any of their respective Subsidiaries
acquiesces in the appointment of a receiver, trustee, custodian, conservator,
liquidator, mortgagee in possession (or agent therefor), or other similar Person
for itself or a substantial portion of its property or business;
<PAGE>
(g) Monetary Judgments. One or more final (non-interlocutory) and
nonappealable judgments, orders or decrees shall be entered against any
Borrower, the Guarantor or any of their respective Subsidiaries
involving in the aggregate a liability (not fully covered by insurance)
as to any single or related series of transactions, incidents or
conditions that have a reasonable likelihood of having a Material
Adverse Effect (which, solely for the purposes hereof, shall be deemed
to mean at least $25,000,000) and the same shall remain undischarged,
unvacated and unstayed pending appeal for a period of 60 days after the
entry thereof;
(h) Guarantor Defaults. The Guarantor shall fail in any material respect to
perform or observe any term, covenant or agreement herein or in the
Guaranty; or the Guaranty shall for any reason be partially (including
with respect to future advances) or wholly revoked or invalidated, or
otherwise cease to be in full force and effect, or the Guarantor or any
other Person shall contest in any manner the validity or enforceability
thereof or deny that it has any further liability or obligation
thereunder;
(i) Guarantor Cross-Acceleration. There shall be any default under any
agreement or instrument evidencing or securing Debt of any Borrower or
the Guarantor (including, without limitation, Debt incurred under the
Guarantor Credit Agreement), if the effect of such default is to permit
the holder or holders of such Debt (or a trustee on its or their
behalf) to cause, and such holder or holders (or trustee) do cause,
such Debt to become due prior to its stated maturity, and the aggregate
amount of such Debt so accelerated equals or exceeds $25,000,000 (or
the equivalent thereof);
(j) Payment Cross-Defaults. Any Borrower or the Guarantor shall default in
the payment when due, after giving effect to any grace period permitted
from time to time, of any Debt (including, without limitation, Debt
incurred under the Guarantor Credit Agreement) and the aggregate amount
of such Debt is at least $25,000,000 (or the equivalent thereof);
(k) Change in Control. A Change in Control shall occur; or
(l) Material Adverse Effect. The occurrence of any circumstance,
development, event or condition which has a Material Adverse Effect.
8.02 REMEDIES. If any Event of Default occurs, the Bank may:
(a) declare the Commitment to be terminated, whereupon the Commitment shall
forthwith be terminated;
(b) declare the unpaid principal amount of all outstanding Loans, all
interest accrued and unpaid thereon, and all other amounts owing or
payable hereunder (including all Reimbursement Obligations) or under
any other Loan Document to be immediately due and payable; without
presentment, demand, protest or other notice of any kind, all of which
are hereby expressly waived by the Borrowers;
(c) exercise all rights and remedies available to it under the Loan
Documents or applicable law; and
(d) require the Borrowers to pay to the Bank in immediately available
funds, in the respective currencies of the applicable Obligations, an
amount equal to the maximum amount then available to be drawn under all
Letters of Credit then outstanding, for deposit in a cash collateral
account maintained by the Bank, as security for the Letters of Credit
then outstanding,
provided, however, that upon the occurrence of any event specified in Section
8.01(e) or Section 8.01(f) (in the case of Section 8.01(f)(i), upon the
expiration of the 60-day period mentioned therein), the Commitment shall
automatically terminate and the unpaid principal amount of all outstanding
Loans, Reimbursement Obligations and all interest and other amounts as aforesaid
shall automatically become due and payable without further act of the Bank.
<PAGE>
8.03 RIGHTS NOT EXCLUSIVE. The rights provided for in this Agreement and the
other Loan Documents are cumulative and are not exclusive of any other rights,
powers, privileges or remedies provided by law or in equity, or under any other
instrument, document or agreement now existing or hereafter arising.
ARTICLE IX
MISCELLANEOUS
9.01 AMENDMENTS AND WAIVERS. No amendment or waiver of any provision of this
Agreement or any other Loan Document to which any Borrower or the Guarantor is
party, and no consent with respect to any departure by any Borrower or the
Guarantor therefrom, shall be effective unless the same shall be in writing and
signed by the Bank, the Borrowers party thereto and the Guarantor, if party
thereto, and then such waiver shall be effective only in the specific instance
and for the specific purpose for which given.
9.02 NOTICES.
-------
(a) All notices, requests and other communications provided for hereunder
shall be in writing (including, unless the context expressly otherwise provides,
telex or fax) and mailed, sent by overnight delivery service, telexed or faxed,
to the address or number specified for notices to the applicable party set forth
on Schedule 9.02 (or, in the case of a Covered Subsidiary, the address specified
for notices in its Election to Participate delivered under Section 5.03(a)); or
to such other address as shall be designated by such party in a written notice
to the other parties.
(b) All such notices, requests and other communications shall, when
transmitted by overnight delivery service, telex or fax, be effective the day
after delivered to the overnight delivery service, when confirmed by telex
answerback or when transmitted by fax with machine transmittal confirmation,
respectively, or, if transmitted by mail, upon delivery, except that notices
pursuant to Article II or Article III shall not be effective until actually
received by the Bank.
(c) The Borrowers acknowledge and agree that the Bank's agreement to
receive notices, requests and other communications by fax is solely for the
convenience and at the request of the Borrowers. The Bank shall be entitled to
rely on the authority of any Person purporting to be a Person authorized by the
applicable Borrower to give such communications and the Bank shall not have any
liability to any Borrower or other Person on account of any action taken or not
taken by the Bank in reliance upon such fax communication. The obligation of the
Borrowers to repay the Obligations shall not be affected in any way or to any
extent by any failure by the Bank to receive written confirmation of any fax
communication or by the receipt by the Bank of a confirmation which is at
variance with the terms understood by the Bank to be contained in the fax
communication.
9.03 NO WAIVER; CUMULATIVE REMEDIES. No failure to exercise and no delay in
exercising, on the part of the Bank, any right, remedy, power or privilege
hereunder, shall operate as a waiver thereof; nor shall any single or partial
exercise of any right, remedy, power or privilege hereunder preclude any other
or further exercise thereof or the exercise of any other right, remedy, power or
privilege.
9.04 COSTS AND EXPENSES. The Borrowers shall, whether or not the
transactions contemplated hereby shall be consummated:
(a) pay or reimburse the Bank within five Business Days after demand (or on
the Effective Date to the extent provided in Section 5.01(g)) for all
reasonable costs and expenses incurred by the Bank in connection with
the delivery and administration of, and any amendment, supplement,
waiver or modification to, this Agreement, any other Loan Document and
any other documents prepared in connection herewith or therewith, and
the consummation of the transactions contemplated hereby and thereby,
including reasonable counsel fees, incurred by the Bank with respect
thereto; and
(b) pay or reimburse the Bank within five Business Days after demand for
all reasonable costs and expenses incurred by it in connection with the
enforcement, attempted enforcement, or preservation of any rights or
remedies (including in connection with any "workout" or restructuring
regarding the Obligations) under this Agreement or any other Loan
Document, including reasonable counsel fees (including the allocated
cost of staff counsel) incurred by the Bank.
9.05 INDEMNITIES. Whether or not the transactions contemplated hereby shall
be consummated:(a) The Borrowers shall pay, indemnify, and hold the
Bank and each of its officers, directors, employees, counsel, agents and
attorneys-in-fact (each, an "Indemnified Person") harmless from and against any
and all liabilities, obligations, losses, damages, penalties, actions,
judgments, suits, costs, charges, expenses or disbursements (including
reasonable counsel fees, including the allocated cost of staff counsel) of any
kind or nature whatsoever with respect to the execution, delivery, enforcement,
performance and administration of this Agreement and any other Loan Document, or
the transactions contemplated hereby and thereby, and with respect to any
investigation, litigation or proceeding related to this Agreement, the Loans or
the Letters of Credit, or the use of the proceeds thereof, whether or not any
Indemnified Person is a party thereto (all the foregoing, collectively, the
"Indemnified Liabilities"); provided, no Borrower shall have any obligation
hereunder to any Indemnified Person with respect to Indemnified Liabilities
arising from the breach of this Agreement by or the gross negligence or willful
misconduct of such Indemnified Person.
(b) The obligations in this Section 9.05 shall survive payment of all other
Obligations. At the election of the Borrowers, one or more Borrowers shall
defend such Indemnified Person using legal counsel satisfactory to such
Indemnified Person in such Person's sole discretion, at the sole cost and
expense of the Borrowers; provided, further that no Borrower may settle any
Indemnified Liability without the Bank's consent (which consent shall not be
unreasonably withheld or delayed). All amounts owing under this Section 9.05
shall be paid within 30 days after demand.
<PAGE>
(c) If any sum due from a Borrower under this Agreement or another Loan
Document or under any order or judgment given or made in relation hereto or
thereto has to be converted from the currency (the "first currency") in which
the same is payable hereunder or thereunder or under such order or judgment into
another currency (the "second currency") for the purpose of (i) making or filing
a claim or proof against such Borrower with any Governmental Authority or in any
court or tribunal or (ii) enforcing any order or judgment given or made in
relation hereto, such Borrower shall indemnify and hold harmless each of the
Persons to whom such sum is due from and against any loss actually suffered as a
result of any discrepancy between (a) the rate of exchange used to convert the
amount in question from the first currency into the second currency and (b) the
rate or rates of exchange at which such Person, acting in good faith in a
commercially reasonable manner, purchased the first currency with the second
currency after receipt of a sum paid to it in the second currency in
satisfaction, in whole or in part, of any such order, judgment, claim or proof.
The foregoing indemnity shall constitute a separate obligation of each Borrower
distinct from its other obligations hereunder and shall survive the giving or
making of any judgment or order in relation to all or any of such other
obligations.
9.06 SUCCESSORS AND ASSIGNS. The provisions of this Agreement shall be binding
upon and inure to the benefit of the parties hereto and their respective
successors and assigns, except that no Borrower nor the Guarantor may assign or
transfer any of its rights or obligations under this Agreement without the prior
written consent of the Bank and any assignment by the Bank must be in compliance
with Section 9.07.
9.07 ASSIGNMENTS AND PARTICIPATIONS. The Bank, with the prior written consent of
the Guarantor, which consent shall not be unreasonably withheld or delayed, may
at any time assign and delegate to one or more Persons (each an "Assignee") all,
or any ratable part of all, of the Advances, the Commitment and the other rights
and obligations of the Bank hereunder; provided, however, that no consent shall
be required for an assignment (i) to an affiliate of the Bank or any approved
Assignee or (ii) during the existence of an Event of Default under Section
8.01(a), (f) or (g); and provided further, that the Borrowers may continue to
deal solely and directly with the Bank in connection with the interest so
assigned to an Assignee until written notice of such assignment, together with
payment instructions, addresses and related information with respect to the
Assignee, shall have been given to the Borrowers by the Bank and the Assignee.
The Bank and any Assignee may, without the consent of the Guarantor or any Bank,
sell participations to one or more banks or other entities (a "Participant") in
all or a portion of the Bank's or Assignee's rights and obligations under this
Agreement (including all or a portion of the Commitment and the Advances owing
to it); provided that (i) the Bank's or Assignee's obligations (including,
without limitation, the Commitment) under this Agreement shall remain unchanged,
(ii) the Bank or Assignee shall remain solely responsible to the other parties
hereto for the performance of such obligations and (iii) the Borrowers and the
Guarantor shall continue to deal solely and directly with the Bank or Assignee
in connection with the Bank's or Assignee's rights and obligations under this
Agreement. Any agreement pursuant to which the Bank or an Assignee sells such a
participation shall provide that the Bank or such Assignee shall retain the sole
right to enforce this Agreement and to approve any amendment, modification or
waiver of any provision of this Agreement. Subject to the next sentence of this
Section, the Guarantor and the Borrowers agree that each Participant shall be
entitled to the benefits and subject to the requirements of Article IV and
Sections 9.04 and 9.05 to the same extent as if it were the Bank or an Assignee
and had acquired its interest by assignment pursuant to this Section. No
Participant shall be entitled to receive any greater payment under Article IV or
Section 9.04 or 9.05 than the Bank or applicable Assignee would have been
entitled to receive with respect to the participation sold to such Participant,
unless the Guarantor specifically consents to such right.
<PAGE>
9.08 CONFIDENTIALITY. The Bank agrees to take normal and reasonable precautions
and exercise due care to maintain the confidentiality of all non-public
information provided to it by the Guarantor, any Borrower or any of their
respective Subsidiaries, in connection with this Agreement or any other Loan
Document, and neither it nor any of its Affiliates shall use any such
information for any purpose or in any manner other than pursuant to the terms
contemplated by this Agreement, except to the extent such information (i) was or
becomes generally available to the public other than as a result of a disclosure
by the Bank, or (ii) was or becomes available on a non-confidential basis from a
source other than the Guarantor or a Borrower, provided that such source is not
bound by a confidentiality agreement with the Guarantor or such Borrower to the
knowledge of the Bank; provided further, however that the Bank may disclose such
information (A) at the request or pursuant to any requirement of any
Governmental Authority to which the Bank is subject or in connection with an
examination of the Bank by any such authority; (B) pursuant to subpoena or other
court process; (C) when required to do so in accordance with the provisions of
any applicable Requirement of Law; and (D) to the Bank's independent auditors
and other professional advisors. Notwithstanding the foregoing, the Borrowers
and the Guarantor authorize the Bank to disclose to any Assignee, and to any
prospective Assignee, such financial and other information in the Bank's
possession concerning the Guarantor, the Borrowers or their respective
Subsidiaries which has been delivered to the Bank pursuant to this Agreement or
which has been delivered to the Bank by the Guarantor, a Borrower, or any of
their respective Subsidiaries in connection with the Bank's credit evaluation of
the Guarantor and the Borrowers prior to entering into, or upon review or
renewal of, this Agreement; provided that, unless otherwise agreed by the
Guarantor and the Borrowers, such Assignee or prospective Assignee agrees in
writing to the Bank to keep such information confidential to the same extent
required of the Bank hereunder.
9.09 COUNTERPARTS. This Agreement may be executed by one or more of the parties
to this Agreement in any number of separate counterparts, each of which, when so
executed, shall be deemed an original, and all of said counterparts taken
together shall be deemed to constitute but one and the same instrument.
9.10 SEVERABILITY. The illegality or unenforceability of any provision of this
Agreement or any instrument or agreement required hereunder shall not in any way
affect or impair the legality or enforceability of the remaining provisions of
this Agreement or any instrument or agreement required hereunder.
<PAGE>
9.11 GOVERNING LAW AND JURISDICTION.
------------------------------
(a) THIS AGREEMENT SHALL BE GOVERNED BY, AND CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE WITH,
THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK; PROVIDED THAT THE BANK SHALL RETAIN ALL
RIGHTS ARISING UNDER FEDERAL LAW.
(b) ANY LEGAL ACTION OR PROCEEDING WITH RESPECT TO THIS AGREEMENT MAY BE
BROUGHT IN THE COURTS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK OR OF THE UNITED STATES FOR THE
SOUTHERN DISTRICT OF NEW YORK, AND, BY EXECUTION AND DELIVERY OF THIS AGREEMENT,
EACH OF THE PARTIES HERETO CONSENTS, FOR ITSELF AND IN RESPECT OF ITS PROPERTY,
TO THE IN PERSONAM JURISDICTION OF THOSE COURTS. EACH OF THE PARTIES HERETO
IRREVOCABLY WAIVES ANY OBJECTION, INCLUDING ANY OBJECTION TO THE LAYING OF VENUE
OR BASED ON THE GROUNDS OF FORUM NON CONVENIENS, WHICH IT MAY NOW OR HEREAFTER
HAVE TO THE BRINGING OF ANY ACTION OR PROCEEDING IN SUCH JURISDICTION IN RESPECT
OF THIS AGREEMENT OR ANY DOCUMENT RELATED HERETO. EACH OF THE PARTIES HERETO
WAIVES PERSONAL SERVICE OF ANY SUMMONS, COMPLAINT OR OTHER PROCESS, WHICH MAY BE
MADE BY ANY OTHER MEANS PERMITTED BY NEW YORK LAW OR BY REGISTERED OR CERTIFIED
MAIL TO SUCH PARTY'S ADDRESS FOR NOTICES PURSUANT TO SECTION 9.02.
9.12 WAIVER OF JURY TRIAL. EACH OF THE PARTIES HERETO WAIVES ITS RIGHTS TO A
TRIAL BY JURY OF ANY CLAIM OR CAUSE OF ACTION BASED UPON OR ARISING OUT OF OR
RELATED TO THIS AGREEMENT, THE OTHER LOAN DOCUMENTS, OR THE TRANSACTIONS
CONTEMPLATED HEREBY OR THEREBY, IN ANY ACTION, PROCEEDING OR OTHER LITIGATION OF
ANY TYPE BROUGHT BY ANY OF THE PARTIES AGAINST ANY OTHER PARTY OR PARTIES,
WHETHER WITH RESPECT TO CONTRACT CLAIMS, TORT CLAIMS, OR OTHERWISE. EACH OF THE
PARTIES HERETO AGREES THAT ANY SUCH CLAIM OR CAUSE OF ACTION SHALL BE TRIED BY A
COURT TRIAL WITHOUT A JURY. WITHOUT LIMITING THE FOREGOING, THE PARTIES FURTHER
AGREE THAT THEIR RESPECTIVE RIGHTS TO A TRIAL BY JURY ARE WAIVED BY OPERATION OF
THIS SECTION 9.12 AS TO ANY ACTION, COUNTERCLAIM OR OTHER PROCEEDING WHICH
SEEKS, IN WHOLE OR IN PART, TO CHALLENGE THE VALIDITY OR ENFORCEABILITY OF THIS
AGREEMENT OR THE OTHER LOAN DOCUMENTS OR ANY PROVISION HEREOF OR THEREOF. THIS
WAIVER SHALL APPLY TO ANY SUBSEQUENT AMENDMENTS, RENEWALS, SUPPLEMENTS OR
MODIFICATIONS TO THIS AGREEMENT AND THE OTHER LOAN DOCUMENTS.
9.13 INCONSISTENCIES WITH OTHER DOCUMENTS. In the event there is a
conflict or inconsistency between this Agreement and any other Loan Document,
the terms of this Agreement shall control.
9.14 ENTIRE AGREEMENT. This Agreement, together with the other Loan Documents,
embodies the entire agreement and understanding between the Borrowers, the
Guarantor and the Bank, and supersedes all prior or contemporaneous agreements
and understandings of such Persons, oral or written, relating to the subject
matter hereof and thereof.
<PAGE>
IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have caused this Agreement to be
duly executed and delivered in New York by their proper and duly authorized
officers as of the day and year first above written.
BORROWERS
BAX GLOBAL INC.
By: /s/ James B. Hartough
-------------------------------------
Name: James B. Hartough
Title: Treasurer and Assistant Secretary
BRINK'S, INCORPORATED
By: /s/ Michael T. Dan
-------------------------------------
Name: Michael T. Dan
Title: Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer
BRINK'S DEUTSCHLAND GMBH
By: /s/ Joseph Eyal
-------------------------------------
Name: Joseph Eyal
Title: Managing Director
BRINK'S BETEILIGUNGSGESELLSCHAFT MBH
By: /s/ Christopher Corrini
-----------------------------------
Name: Christopher Corrini
Title: Managing Director
BRINK'S DIAMOND & JEWELRY SERVICE NV
By: /s/ Michael T. Dan
-------------------------------------
Name: Michael T. Dan
Title: Chairman and Director
<PAGE>
BRINK'S NEDERLAND B.V.
By: /s/ Ian Sanders
-------------------------------------
Name: Ian Sanders
Title: Director
BRINK'S AUSTRALIA PTY LTD.
By: /s/ Christopher Corrini
-----------------------------------
Name: Christopher Corrini
Title: Director
GUARANTOR
THE PITTSTON COMPANY
By: /s/ James B. Hartough
-------------------------------------
Name: James B. Hartough
Title: Vice President - Corporate Finance
and Treasurer
BANK
BAYERISCHE HYPO- UND VEREINSBANK AG
By: /s/ Ricarda Soltanmoradi
-----------------------------------
Name: Ricarda Soltanmoradi
Title: Managing Director
By: /s/ Christina Winkler-Kruse
-------------------------------------
Name: Christina Winkler-Kruse
Title: Senior Credit Analyst
</TEXT>
</DOCUMENT>
<DOCUMENT>
<TYPE>EX-10
<SEQUENCE>4
<FILENAME>hypobankguaranty_nov12.txt
<DESCRIPTION>HYPO BANK GUARANTY
<TEXT>
GUARANTY
GUARANTY, dated as of November 12, 2002 made by THE PITTSTON COMPANY, a Virginia
corporation (the "Guarantor"), in favor of BAYERISCHE HYPO- UND VEREINSBANK AG
(the "Bank"), and each Assignee under the Credit Agreement referred to below
(collectively, the "Lenders").
W I T N E S S E T H :
WHEREAS, the Bank is willing, subject to the conclusion of satisfactory
documentation and the satisfaction of other conditions, to extend credit, and to
facilitate the extension of credit by certain of the Bank's foreign lending
offices (as Lending Offices), from time to time to BAX Global Inc., a Delaware
corporation ("BAX") and Brink's, Incorporated, a Delaware corporation
("Brink's"), subsidiaries of the Guarantor, and to certain subsidiaries of BAX
and Brink's which are now or later become parties to the Credit Agreement dated
as of November 12, 2002, among BAX, BRINK'S, BRINK'S DEUTSCHLAND GMBH, a German
limited liability company, BRINK'S BETEILIGUNGSGESELLSCHAFT MBH, a German
limited liability company, BRINK'S DIAMOND & JEWELRY SERVICE NV, a Belgium
corporation, BRINK'S NEDERLAND B.V., a Dutch corporation, and BRINK'S AUSTRALIA
PTY LTD., an Australian corporation and the Covered Subsidiaries that become
parties thereto from time to time as Borrowers, the Guarantor, the Bank and the
other financial institutions that become parties from time to time thereto as
Assignees, as the same may be amended from time to time thereafter (the "Credit
Agreement"); and it is a condition precedent to the extension of credit from
time to time to the Borrowers under the Credit Agreement that the Guarantor
shall have executed and delivered and keep in full force and effect this
Guaranty.
NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the premises and to induce the Bank and its
Lending Offices to extend credit from time to time to the Borrowers under the
Credit Agreement, the Guarantor hereby agrees with the Bank as follows:
1. DEFINED TERMS. Capitalized terms not otherwise defined herein
-------------
shall have the same meaning given to such terms in the Credit Agreement.
2. GUARANTY. The Guarantor hereby unconditionally and irrevocably
guarantees to the Lenders the prompt and complete payment in full and
performance by the Borrowers when due (whether at the stated maturity, by
acceleration or otherwise) of the Obligations in the currency or currencies in
which the Obligations are denominated from time to time. The Guarantor further
agrees to pay any and all expenses, including, without limitation, all
reasonable fees and disbursements of counsel (including, without limitation,
allocated costs of staff counsel) which may be paid or incurred by the Lenders
in enforcing and preserving any of their respective rights under this Guaranty
and such as may be incurred by the Bank in connection with the preparation,
negotiation, execution, delivery and administration hereof. This Guaranty shall
remain in full force and effect until the Obligations are paid in full and the
Commitment is terminated, notwithstanding that from time to time prior thereto
any Borrowers may have been free from any Obligations.
<PAGE>
The Guarantor agrees that whenever, at any time, or from time to time, it shall
make any payment to the Bank or any Lending Office on account of its liability
hereunder, it will notify the Bank and such relevant Lending Office in writing
that such payment is made under this Guaranty for such purpose. No payment or
payments made by a Borrower or any other Person or received or collected by any
Lender from a Borrower or any other Person by virtue of any action or proceeding
or any set-off or appropriation or application, at any time or from time to
time, in reduction of or in payment of the Obligations shall be deemed to
modify, reduce, release or otherwise affect the liability of the Guarantor
hereunder which shall, notwithstanding any such payment or payments, remain
liable for the amount of the Obligations as aforesaid until the Obligations are
paid in full and the Commitment is terminated.
3. SUBROGATION. The Guarantor expressly waives any and all rights of
subrogation, reimbursement and contribution (contractual, statutory or
otherwise), including any claim or right of subrogation under the Bankruptcy
Code (Title 11 of the U.S. Code) or any successor statute, arising from the
existence or performance of this Guaranty, and the Guarantor irrevocably waives
any right to enforce any remedy, which any Lender now has or may hereafter have
against any Borrower, and waives any benefit of, and any right to participate
in, any security now or hereafter held by any of them. The provisions of this
paragraph 0 shall survive the termination of this Guaranty and the payment in
full of the Obligations; provided, however, that the foregoing waiver shall be
of no force and effect 370 days following the termination of this Guaranty and
the payment in full of the Obligations, but only if during such 370-day period
no Borrower nor the Guarantor shall have commenced or have commenced against it
a bankruptcy proceeding under the Bankruptcy Code or similar law under any state
or foreign jurisdiction.
4. AMENDMENTS, ETC. WITH RESPECT TO THE OBLIGATIONS. The Guarantor
shall remain obligated hereunder notwithstanding that, without any reservation
of rights against the Guarantor, and without notice to or further assent by the
Guarantor, any demand for payment of any of the Obligations made by any Lender
may be rescinded, and any of the obligations continued, and the Obligations, or
the liability of any other party upon or for any part thereto, may, from time to
time, in whole or in part, be renewed, extended, amended, modified, accelerated,
compromised, waived, surrendered or released by any Lender, and any agreement or
instrument relating to the extension of credit by any Lender to any Borrower,
any Note, and any other document in connection therewith may be amended,
modified, supplemented or terminated, in whole or in part, as any Lender may
deem advisable from time to time, and any collateral security, guarantee or
right of offset at any time held by any Lender for the payment of the
Obligations may be sold, exchanged, waived, surrendered or released. No Lender
shall have any obligation to protect, secure, perfect or insure any lien at any
time held by it as security for the Obligations or for this Guaranty or any
property subject thereto.
5. WAIVER OF RIGHTS; GUARANTEE ABSOLUTE AND UNCONDITIONAL. The
Guarantor waives any and all notice of the creation, renewal, extension or
accrual of any of the Obligations and notice of or proof of reliance by the
Lenders upon this Guaranty or acceptance of this Guaranty; the Obligations, and
any of them, shall conclusively be deemed to have been created, contracted or
incurred in reliance upon this Guaranty; and all dealings between any Borrower
or the Guarantor, on the one hand, and any Lender, on the other, shall likewise
be conclusively presumed to have been had or consummated in reliance upon this
Guaranty.
-2-
<PAGE>
The Guarantor waives diligence, presentment, protest, demand for
payment and notice of default or nonpayment to or upon any Borrower or the
Guarantor with respect to the Obligations. This Guaranty shall be construed as a
continuing, absolute and unconditional guarantee of payment without regard to
(a) the validity or enforceability of any of the Loan Documents, any of the
Obligations or any collateral security therefor or guarantee or right of offset
with respect thereto at any time or from time to time held by any Lender, (b)
any defense, set-off or counterclaim (other than a defense of payment or
performance) which may at any time be available to or be asserted by any
Borrower against any Lender, or (c) any other circumstance whatsoever (with or
without notice to or knowledge of any Borrower or the Guarantor) which
constitutes, or might be construed to constitute, an equitable or legal
discharge of any Borrower for the Obligations, or of the Guarantor under this
Guaranty, in bankruptcy or in any other instance, and the Obligations may be
declared to be forthwith due and payable as provided under Article VIII of the
Credit Agreement (and shall be deemed to have become automatically due and
payable in case of defaults arising under Sections 8.01(d) or (e) of the Credit
Agreement) notwithstanding any stay, injunction or other prohibition preventing
such declaration as against any other Person and that, in the event of such
declaration (or the Obligations being deemed to have become automatically due
and payable), the Obligations shall forthwith become due and payable by the
Guarantor. When pursuing its rights and remedies hereunder against the
Guarantor, any Lender may, but shall be under no obligation to, pursue such
rights and remedies as it may have against any Borrower or any other Person or
against any collateral security or guarantee for the Obligations or any right of
offset with respect thereto, and any failure by such Lender to pursue such other
rights or remedies or to collect any payments from any Borrower or any such
other Person or to realize upon any such collateral security or guarantee or to
exercise any such right of offset, or any release of any Borrower or any such
other Person or any such collateral security, guarantee or right of offset,
shall not relieve the Guarantor of any liability hereunder, and shall not impair
or affect the rights and remedies, whether express, implied or available as a
matter of law, of any Lender against the Guarantor.
6. REINSTATEMENT. This Guaranty shall continue to be effective, or be
reinstated, as the case may be, if at any time payment, or any part thereof, of
any of the Obligations is rescinded or must otherwise be restored or returned by
any Lender upon the insolvency, bankruptcy, dissolution, liquidation or
reorganization of any Borrower or upon or as a result of the appointment of a
receiver, intervenor or conservator of, or trustee or similar officer for any
Borrower or any substantial part of its property, or otherwise, all as though
such payments had not been made.
7. PAYMENTS. The Guarantor hereby agrees that the Obligations will be
paid to the Lenders without set-off or counterclaim in the currency or
currencies in which such Obligations are denominated from time to time at the
Lending Office identified in the documentation governing such Obligations, at
such office of the Bank.
8. REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES. The Guarantor represents and
warrants that:
(a) the Guarantor (i) is a corporation duly organized, validly existing
and in good standing under the laws of the jurisdiction of the
Commonwealth of Virginia, (ii) has the corporate power and authority
and the legal right to own and operate its property, to lease the
property it operates under lease and to conduct the business in which
it is currently
-3-
<PAGE>
engaged, and (iii) is qualified to do business in every
jurisdiction where such qualification is required, except where the
failure to so qualify would not have a Material Adverse Effect;
(b) the Guarantor has the corporate power and authority and the legal
right to execute and deliver, and to perform its obligations under,
this Guaranty, and has taken all necessary corporate action to
authorize its execution, delivery and performance of this Guaranty;
(c) this Guaranty constitutes a legal, valid and binding obligation of
the Guarantor enforceable in accordance with its terms, except as
enforceability may be limited by bankruptcy, insolvency,
reorganization, moratorium or similar laws affecting the enforcement of
creditors' rights generally;
(d) the execution, delivery and performance of this Guaranty will not
(i) violate any provision of any law or regulation or of any judgment,
order, decree, determination or award of any court, arbitrator or
governmental authority, bureau or agency or of the charter, by-laws or
other corporate rules of, or any securities issued by, the Guarantor,
(ii) result in a breach of or constitute a default under any mortgage,
indenture, loan or security agreement, lease, contract or other
agreement, instrument or undertaking to which the Guarantor is a party
or which purports to be binding upon it or any of its properties or
assets, or (iii) result in or require the creation or imposition of any
lien on any of the properties or revenues of the Guarantor pursuant to
the provisions of any of the foregoing;
(e) no consent or authorization of, filing with, or other act by or in
respect of, any Governmental Authority, and no consent of any other
person (including, without limitation, any stockholder or creditor of
the Guarantor) is required in connection with the execution, delivery,
performance, validity or enforceability of this Guaranty; and
(f) except as disclosed to the Bank in writing (including disclosure by
delivery of financial statements to the Bank pursuant to Section
5.01(i) of the Credit Agreement), no litigation, investigation or
proceeding of or before any arbitrator or governmental authority,
bureau or agency is pending or, to the knowledge of the Guarantor,
threatened by or against the Guarantor or against any of its properties
or revenues (i) with respect to this Guaranty or any of the
transactions contemplated hereby or (ii) the probable outcome of which
would have a Material Adverse Effect;
9. STATUS OF BORROWERS. The Guarantor represents and warrants as of the
date hereof that the Guarantor directly or indirectly owns and has the power to
vote at least 51% of the voting interests of each of BAX and Brink's, that BAX
directly or indirectly owns at least 51% of the voting interests of each of the
BAX Covered Subsidiaries that are party to the Credit Agreement, and that
Brink's directly or indirectly owns at least 51% of the voting interests of each
of the Brink's Covered Subsidiaries that are party to the Credit Agreement.
Notwithstanding any sale or transfer of any ownership interest in any Borrower,
the Guarantor will continue to be bound by the terms of this Guaranty in all
respects including without limitation to guaranty the Obligations of each
Minority Owned Borrower.
-4-
<PAGE>
The Guarantor hereby acknowledges and agrees that the
representations and warranties contained in the first sentence of this paragraph
0 shall be deemed repeated as of the date of each Advance made after the
Effective Date and as of the date of effectiveness of each Election to
Participate requesting that an additional Covered Subsidiary be made a party to,
and a Borrower under, the Credit Agreement after the Effective Date.
10. SEVERABILITY. Any provision of this Guaranty which is prohibited or
unenforceable in any jurisdiction shall, as to such jurisdiction, be ineffective
to the extent of such prohibition or unenforceability without invalidating the
remaining provisions hereof, and any such prohibition or unenforceability in any
jurisdiction shall not invalidate or render unenforceable such provision in any
other jurisdiction.
11. PARAGRAPH HEADINGS. The paragraph headings used in this
Guaranty are for convenience of reference only and are not to affect the
construction hereof or be taken into consideration in the interpretation
hereof.
12. NO WAIVER: CUMULATIVE REMEDIES. Neither the Bank nor any Lending
Office affiliates, branches or subsidiaries shall by any act (except by a
written instrument pursuant to paragraph 0 hereof), delay, indulgence, omission
or otherwise be deemed to have waived any right or remedy hereunder or to have
acquiesced in any default or in any breach of any of the terms and conditions
hereof. No failure to exercise, nor any delay in exercising, on the part of the
Bank or any Lending Office, any right, power or privilege hereunder shall
operate as a waiver thereof. No single or partial exercise of any right, power
or privilege hereunder shall preclude any other or further exercise thereof or
the exercise of any other right, power or privilege. A waiver by the Bank or any
Lending Office of any right or remedy hereunder on any one occasion shall not be
construed as a bar to any right or remedy which the Bank or such Lending Office
would otherwise have on any future occasion. The rights and remedies herein
provided are cumulative, may be exercised singly or concurrently and are not
exclusive of any rights or remedies provided by law.
13. WAIVERS AND AMENDMENTS; SUCCESSORS AND ASSIGNS: GOVERNING LAW.
Except as otherwise set forth in paragraph 0 hereof, none of the terms or
provisions of this Guaranty may be waived, amended, supplemented or otherwise
modified except by a written instrument executed by the Guarantor and the Bank;
provided that any provision of this Guaranty may be waived by the Bank in a
letter or agreement executed by the Bank or by telex or fax transmission by the
Bank. This Guaranty shall be binding upon the successors and assigns of the
Guarantor and shall inure to the benefit of the Bank, all Lending Offices and
their respective successors and assigns. THIS GUARANTY IS A GUARANTEE OF PAYMENT
AND NOT SOLELY OF COLLECTION AND SHALL BE GOVERNED BY, AND CONSTRUED AND
INTERPRETED IN ACCORDANCE WITH, THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK.
14. JUDGMENT CURRENCY.
(a) The Guarantor's obligations under this Guaranty to make payments to
any Lenders in the currency or currencies in which the Obligations are
denominated in the documentation governing such Obligations (the
"Obligations Currency") shall not be discharged or satisfied by any
tender or recovery pursuant to any judgment expressed in
-5-
<PAGE>
or converted into any other currency, except to the extent that such
tender or recovery results in the effective receipt by the Lenders of
the full amount of the Obligations Currency payable to the Lenders
under this Guaranty, and the Guarantor shall indemnify the Lenders
(and the Lenders shall have an additional legal claim) for any
difference between such full amount and the amount effectively received
by such Person pursuant to any such tender or recovery. The
determination by any Lender of amounts effectively received by it shall
be conclusive absent manifest error.
(b) (i)i If for the purpose of obtaining or enforcing any
judgment against the Guarantor in any court in any
jurisdiction, it becomes necessary to convert into any
currency other than the Obligations Currency (such currency
being hereinafter in this paragraph 0 referred to as the
"Judgment Currency") an amount due in the Obligations Currency
under this Guaranty, the conversion shall be made, at the
option of the Bank or the relevant Lending Office, at the rate
of exchange prevailing on the business day immediately
preceding the day on which the judgment is given (such
business day being hereinafter in this paragraph 0 referred to
as the "Conversion Date").
(ii)ii If there is a change in the rate of exchange prevailing
between the Conversion Date and the date of actual payment of
the amount due, the Guarantor covenants and agrees to pay such
additional amounts (if any, but in any event not a lesser
amount) as may be necessary to ensure that the amount paid in
the Judgment Currency, when converted at the rate of exchange
prevailing on the date of payment, will produce the amount of
the Obligations Currency which could have been purchased with
the amount of Judgment Currency stipulated in the judgment of
judicial award at the rate of exchange prevailing on the
Conversion Date.
(c) Any amount due from the Guarantor under the foregoing paragraph
will be due as a separate debt and shall not be affected by judgment
being obtained for any other sums due under or in respect of this
Guaranty.
(d) The term "rate of exchange" in this paragraph 0 means the Bank's or
the relevant Lending Office's rate of exchange on the relevant date
applicable to the purchase of the Obligations Currency with the
Judgment Currency or, if such rate is not so published by the Bank or
such Lending Office, such term shall mean the spot rate at which the
Bank or such Lending Office in accordance with its normal practices is
able on the relevant date to purchase the Obligations Currency with the
Judgment Currency and includes in either case any premium and costs of
exchange payable in connection with such purchase.
15. SUBMISSION TO JURISDICTION. The Guarantor hereby irrevocably agrees
that any legal action, suit or proceeding against it with respect to its
obligations, liabilities or any other matter under or arising out of or in
connection with this Guaranty or for recognition or enforcement of any judgment
rendered in any such action, suit or proceeding may be brought in the United
States Courts for the Southern District of New York, or in the courts of the
State of New York, as the Bank or, if applicable, any Lending Office may elect,
and, by execution and delivery of this Guaranty, the Guarantor hereby
irrevocably accepts and submits to the non-
-6-
<PAGE>
exclusive jurisdiction of each of the
aforesaid courts in personam generally and unconditionally with respect to any
such action, suit or proceeding for itself and in respect of its property. The
Guarantor further agrees that final judgment against it in any action, suit or
proceeding referred to herein shall be conclusive and may be enforced in any
other jurisdiction, within or outside the United States of America, by suit on
the judgment, a certified or exemplified copy of which shall be conclusive
evidence of the fact and of the amount of its indebtedness. The Guarantor hereby
irrevocably designates and appoints Brink's, Incorporated at the address of its
registered agent in the State of New York (which, as of the date hereof, is CT
Corporation System, currently located at 111 Eighth Avenue, New York, New York
10011) as the designee, appointee and agent of the Guarantor to receive, accept
and acknowledge for and on behalf of the Guarantor and its property service of
any and all legal process, summons, notices and documents which may be served in
any such action, suit or proceeding in the case of United States Courts for the
Southern District of New York and the courts of the State of New York, which
service may be made on such designee, appointee and agent in accordance with
legal procedures prescribed for such courts. It is agreed that if any legal
process, summons, notice or document shall be served upon Brink's, Incorporated
at the address of such registered agent with respect to the Guarantor in
connection herewith, notice thereof shall promptly be provided to the Guarantor
at the address set forth on the signature page hereof; provided, that the
failure to provide any such notice shall not affect the validity of such service
upon Brink's, Incorporated as agent for and on behalf of Guarantor, at the
address of such registered agent. The Guarantor agrees to take any and all such
action necessary to continue such designation in full force and effect and to
advise the Bank on its behalf and on behalf of each other Lender of any change
of address of such designee, appointee and agent; and should said designee,
appointee and agent become unavailable for this purpose for any reason, the
Guarantor will forthwith irrevocably designate a new designee, appointee and
agent within the City of New York, New York, which shall irrevocably consent to
act as such, with the powers and for the purposes specified in this paragraph.
The Guarantor further irrevocably consents and agrees to the service of any and
all legal process, summons, notices, and documents out of any of the aforesaid
courts in any such action, suit or proceeding by mailing copies thereof by
registered or certified mail, postage prepaid, to the Guarantor at its address
set forth with its signature below or to its then designee, appointee and agent
for service. The Guarantor agrees that service upon it or any such designee,
appointee, and agent as provided for herein shall constitute a valid and
effective personal service upon it and that the failure of any such designee,
appointee and agent to give any notice of such service to it shall not impair or
affect in any way the validity of such service. Nothing herein contained shall,
or shall be construed so as to, limit the right of the Bank or any other Lender
to bring actions, suits or proceedings with respect to the obligations and
liabilities of the Guarantor under, or any other matter arising out of or in
connection with, this Guaranty, or for recognition or enforcement of any
judgment rendered in any such action, suit or proceeding, in the courts of
whatever jurisdiction in which the office of the Bank or such Lending Office or
Assignee deems appropriate, or to affect the right to service of process in any
jurisdiction in any other manner permitted by the law.
In addition, the Guarantor hereby irrevocably and unconditionally waives any
objection which it may now or hereafter have to the laying of venue of any of
the aforesaid actions, suits or proceedings arising out of or in connection with
this Guaranty brought in any of the aforesaid courts, and hereby further
irrevocably and unconditionally waives and agrees not to plead any
-7-
<PAGE>
claim that any such action, suit or proceeding brought in any such court has
been broughtin an inconvenient forum.
Each party hereto waives its rights to a trial by jury of any claim or cause of
action based upon or arising out of or related to this Guaranty, or the
transactions contemplated hereby or thereby, in any action, proceeding or other
litigation of any type brought by any party against the other party.
16. NOTICES. All notices, requests and other communications provided
for hereunder shall be in writing (including, unless the context expressly
otherwise provides, telex or fax) and mailed, sent by overnight delivery
service, telexed or faxed, to the address or number specified for notices to the
applicable party set forth on Schedule 9.02 to the Credit Agreement or to such
other address as shall be designated by such party in a written notice to the
other parties.
All such notices, requests and other communications shall, when transmitted by
overnight delivery service, telex or fax, be effective the day after delivered
to the overnight delivery service, when confirmed by telex answerback or when
transmitted by fax with machine transmittal confirmation, respectively, or, if
transmitted by mail, upon delivery, except that notices pursuant to Article II
or Article III of the Credit Agreement shall not be effective until actually
received by the Bank.
The Guarantor acknowledges and agrees that the Bank's agreement to receive
notices, requests and other communications by fax is solely for the convenience
and at the request of the Guarantor. Each Lender shall be entitled to rely on
the authority of any Person purporting to be a Person authorized by the
Guarantor to give such communications and no Lender shall have any liability to
Guarantor or any other Person on account of any action taken or not taken by
such Lender in reliance upon such fax communication. The obligations of the
Guarantor hereunder shall not be affected in any way or to any extent by any
failure by the Bank or any other Lender to receive written confirmation of any
fax communication or by the receipt of a confirmation which is at variance with
the terms understood by such Lender to be contained in the fax communication.
17. COUNTERPARTS; FACSIMILE SIGNATURES. This Guaranty may be executed
by one or more of the parties in separate counterparts, each of which, when so
executed, shall be deemed an original, and all of said counterparts taken
together shall be deemed to constitute but one and the same instrument. The
parties hereto confirm that any facsimile copy of another party's executed
counterpart of this Guaranty (or its signature page thereof) will be deemed to
be an executed original thereof.
[SIGNATURES APPEAR ON NEXT PAGE]
-8-
<PAGE>
IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the undersigned has caused this Guaranty to be duly executed
and delivered as of the date first above written.
THE PITTSTON COMPANY
By: /s/ James B. Hartough
----------------------------
Name: James B. Hartough
Title: Vice President - Corporate Finance
and Treasurer
ACKNOWLEDGED:
BAYERISCHE HYPO- UND VEREINSBANK AG
By: /s/ Ricarda Soltanmoradi
--------------------------------------------
Name: Ricarda Soltanmoradi
Title: Managing Director
By: /s/ Christina Winkler-Kruse
-----------------------------------------------------
Name: Christina Winkler-Kruse
Title: Senior Credit Analyst
-9-
<PAGE>
</TEXT>
</DOCUMENT>
<DOCUMENT>
<TYPE>EX-10
<SEQUENCE>5
<FILENAME>creditagree_abnamro.txt
<DESCRIPTION>ABN AMRO CREDIT AGREEMENT
<TEXT>
CREDIT AGREEMENT
DATED AS OF DECEMBER 20, 2002
AMONG
BAX GLOBAL INC.,
BRINK'S, INCORPORATED,
THE PITTSTON COMPANY
AND
ABN AMRO BANK N.V.
<PAGE>
CREDIT AGREEMENT
This CREDIT AGREEMENT is entered into as of December 20, 2002 among (i)
BAX GLOBAL INC., a Delaware corporation formerly known as Burlington Air Express
Inc. ("BAX"), (ii) BRINK'S, INCORPORATED, a Delaware corporation ("Brink's"),
and (iii) THE PITTSTON COMPANY, a Virginia corporation, (the "Pittston") (BAX,
Brink's and Pittston are sometimes hereinafter referred to as "Borrowers" and
"Guarantors"), and (iv) ABN AMRO BANK N.V. (the "Bank").
WHEREAS, the parties enter into this Agreement to set forth the terms
and conditions upon which the Bank will extend to the Borrowers, a $45,000,000
(the "Commitment") revolving credit facility for a three-year period ( the
"Facility"), in part to refinance facilities currently extended by the Bank;
WHEREAS, upon the written request of any Borrower and upon
written advice from the Bank to the requesting Borrower agreeing thereto, any
portion of the then unused Commitment may be allocated for use by any Subsidiary
of BAX listed on Schedule A-1 hereto or by any Subsidiary of Brink's listed on
Schedule A-2 hereto, as the same may be supplemented and amended from time to
time with the written consent of the Bank, at a branch or Affiliate (as
hereinafter defined) of the Bank, provided, that at all times the Guaranties (as
hereinafter defined) of the Guarantors shall apply to all such extensions of
credit by all such branches and Affiliates of the Bank;
WHEREAS, pursuant to a Credit Agreement, dated as of December 22, 1999,
as renewed and amended from time to time thereafter, the Bank has extended a
revolving credit facility (the "1999 Revolving Facility") to BAX, Brink's and
certain of the BAX Covered Subsidiaries and Brink's Covered Subsidiaries (as
both terms are defined therein), which facility is terminating and expiring in
accordance with its terms;
WHEREAS, the Facility provided hereunder shall be available immediately
upon the termination of the 1999 Revolving Facility in accordance with its
terms, provided the conditions precedent set forth below have been satisfied;
NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the mutual agreements, provisions
and covenants contained herein, the parties hereto hereby agree as follows:
ARTICLE I
DEFINITIONS
1.01 Defined Terms1.01 Defined Terms.01 Defined Terms.01 Defined
Terms. In addition to the terms defined in the recitals to this Agreement,
the following terms have the following meanings:
"Advances" has the meaning assigned thereto in Section 2.01.
"Affiliate" means, with respect to any Person, any other
Person (other than a Subsidiary) which directly or indirectly through
one or more intermediaries, controls,
<PAGE>
or is controlled by, or is under
common control with, such first Person or any of its Subsidiaries. The
term "control" means the possession, directly or indirectly, of any
power to direct or cause the direction of the management and policies
of a Person, whether through ownership of voting securities, by
contract or otherwise.
"Agreement" means this Credit Agreement, as it may be amended,
supplemented or modified from time to time hereafter.
"Approved Currencies" means Dollars and other currencies as
are available to a Borrower for Loans and Letters of Credit or a
Covered Subsidiary for credit extensions by a branch or Affiliate of
the Bank and which are freely transferable and convertible into
Dollars.
"Assignee" has the meaning assigned thereto in Section 9.07.
"Bankruptcy Code" means Title 11 of the United States Code,
entitled "Bankruptcy", as now or hereinafter in effect and any
successor thereto.
"Base Rate" means the higher of:
(a) the rate of interest publicly announced from time
to time by the Bank as its "reference rate" or its "prime
rate" (which publicly announced rate is a rate set by the Bank
based upon various factors including the Bank's costs and
desired return, general economic conditions and other factors,
and is used as a reference point for pricing some loans, which
may be priced at, above, or below such announced rate); and
(b) one-half percent per annum above the latest
Federal Funds Rate. Any change in the reference rate or prime rate
announced by the Bank shall take effect at the
opening of business on the day specified in the public announcement of
such change."Base Rate Loan" means a Loan that bears interest based on
the Base Rate.
"Business Day" means any day other than a Saturday, Sunday or
other day on which commercial banks in New York City and Chicago are
authorized or required by law to close except in the case of LIBOR Rate
Loans, "Business Day" means any day other than a Saturday, Sunday or
other day on which commercial banks in New York, Chicago and London,
England are authorized or required by law to close.
"Capital Adequacy Regulation" means any guideline, request or
directive of any central bank or other Governmental Authority, or any
other law, rule or regulation, whether or not having the force of law,
in each case, regarding capital adequacy of any bank or of any
corporation controlling a bank.
-2-
<PAGE>
"Capital Lease" means any lease of property which should be
capitalized on the lessee's balance sheet in accordance with GAAP; and
"Capital Lease Obligation" means the amount of the liability so
capitalized.
"Code" means the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended.
"Commercial Letter of Credit" means a documentary letter of
credit which is drawable upon presentation of documents evidencing the
sale or shipment of goods purchased by a Borrower or any Covered
Subsidiary in the ordinary course of its business.
"Commitment" means the commitment of the Bank under this
Agreement to make Advances pursuant to the Facility in an aggregate
principal amount not to exceed $45,000,000, as such amount may be
reduced from time to time pursuant to the terms of this Agreement.
"Commitment Fee Rate" means the applicable percentage set
forth below based upon the higher of the S&P Rating or the Moody's
Rating on the last day of the calendar quarter with respect to which
the commitment fee is being calculated, provided, that if on any such
date the S&P Rating and the Moody's Rating do not fall into contiguous
columns under the following grid, then the applicable percentage set
forth below based upon the lower of the S&P or the Moody's Rating on
the last day of such calendar quarter (but no lower than the applicable
percentage in the column contiguous with the higher of the S&P or the
Moody's Rating):
<TABLE>
----------- ------------- ------------- --------------- --------------- --------------
<S> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C>
S&P A-
Rating BBB+ BBB BBB- BB+ Below BB+
or higher
- ----------------- ----------- ------------- ------------- --------------- --------------- --------------
Moody's Rating A3 Baa1 Baa2 Baa3 Ba1 Below Ba1
or higher
- ----------------- ----------- ------------- ------------- --------------- --------------- --------------
Commitment Fee 0.125% 0.15% 0.175% 0.225% 0.30% 0.40%
Rate
- ------------------ ------------ -------------- -------------- ---------------- ---------------- ---------------
</TABLE>
If the rating system used to ascribe either the S&P Rating or
the Moody's Rating shall change prior to the Termination Date, the
Borrowers and the Bank shall negotiate in good faith to amend the
references to specific ratings in this definition to reflect such
changed rating system.
-3-
<PAGE>
"Consolidated Debt" means the Debt of Pittston and its
Restricted Subsidiaries, determined on a consolidated basis in
accordance with GAAP after giving appropriate effect to any outside
minority interests in Restricted Subsidiaries.
"Consolidated EBITDA" means, for Pittston and its Restricted
Subsidiaries for any period, an amount equal to the sum of (a)
Consolidated Net Income for such period plus (b) to the extent deducted
in determining Consolidated Net Income for such period, (i)
Consolidated Interest Expense, (ii) income tax expense, (iii)
depreciation, depletion and amortization, and (iv) all other non-cash
charges, determined on a consolidated basis in accordance with GAAP
after giving appropriate effect to any outside minority interests in
the Restricted Subsidiaries.
"Consolidated Interest Expense" means, for any period, as
applied to Pittston and its Restricted Subsidiaries, all interest
expense (whether paid or accrued) and capitalized interest, including
without limitation (a) the amortization of debt discount and premium,
(b) the interest component under Capital Leases, and (c) the implied
interest component, discount or other similar fees or charges in
connection with any asset securitization program in each case
determined on a consolidated basis in accordance with GAAP after giving
appropriate effect to any outside minority interests in the Restricted
Subsidiaries.
"Consolidated Lease Rentals" means Lease Rentals of Pittston
and its Restricted Subsidiaries, determined on a consolidated basis in
accordance with GAAP after giving appropriate effect to any outside
minority interests in the Restricted Subsidiaries.
"Consolidated Net Income" means, for any period, the net
income, after taxes, of Pittston and its Restricted Subsidiaries for
such period determined on a consolidated basis in accordance with GAAP
after giving appropriate effect to any outside minority interests in
the Restricted Subsidiaries, but excluding, to the extent reflected in
determining such net income, (a) any extraordinary gains and losses for
such period, (b) for any period ending before January 1, 2003, any loss
arising from or relating to the initial classification of any portion
of the Pittston Minerals Group as discontinued operations and any
subsequent adjustments associated with the disposition of such
discontinued operations, (c) any impairment, write-down or write-off in
the book value of any assets and (d) any loss in connection with the
disposition of any assets.
"Consolidated Net Worth" means, as of any date, as applied to
Pittston and its Restricted Subsidiaries, shareholders' equity or net
worth as determined and computed on a consolidated basis in accordance
with GAAP after giving appropriate effect to any outside minority
interests in the Restricted Subsidiaries, provided that in determining
"Consolidated Net Worth" there shall be (a) included any issuance of
preferred stock by Pittston and (b) excluded (i) any extraordinary
gains and losses, (ii) any loss arising from or relating to the initial
classification of any portion of the Pittston Minerals Group as
discontinued operations and any subsequent adjustments associated with
the disposition of such discontinued operations, to the extent any such
loss or adjustment occurs before
-4-
<PAGE>
January 1, 2003, (iii) any impairment,
write-down or write-off in the book value of any assets (including any
reduction in shareholders' equity in connection with a reduction in the
value of a prepaid Pension Plan or Foreign Pension Plan) and (iv) any
loss in connection with the disposition of any assets.
"Consolidated Total Assets" means, as of any date, the assets
and properties of Pittston and its Restricted Subsidiaries, determined
on a consolidated basis in accordance with GAAP after giving
appropriate effect to any outside minority interests in the Restricted
Subsidiaries.
"Contaminant" shall mean any waste, hazardous material,
hazardous substance, toxic substance, hazardous waste, special waste,
petroleum or petroleum-derived substance or waste, including any such
pollutant, material, substance or waste regulated under any
Environmental Law.
"Control", "Controlling" and "Controlled" means the power,
direct or indirect, of one Person to direct or cause the direction of
the management and policies of another, whether by contract, through
voting securities or otherwise.
"Covered Subsidiaries" means the Subsidiaries of BAX and
Brink's listed on Schedule B-1, as the same may be supplemented and
amended with the written consent of the Bank.
Debt" of any Person means at any date, without duplication,
the sum of the following determined and calculated in accordance with
GAAP: (a) all obligations of such Person for borrowed money, (b) all
obligations of such Person issued or assumed as the deferred purchase
price of property or services purchased by such Person (other than
trade debt incurred in the ordinary course of business and due within
six months of the incurrence thereof) which would appear as liabilities
on a balance sheet of such Person, (c) all Debt of others secured by
(or for which the holder of such Debt has an existing right, contingent
or otherwise, to be secured by) any Lien on, or payable out of the
proceeds of production from, property owned or acquired by such Person,
whether or not the obligations secured thereby have been assumed,
provided that for purposes hereof the amount of such Debt shall be
calculated at the greater of (i) the amount of such Debt as to which
there is recourse to such Person and (ii) the fair market value of the
property which is subject to the Lien, (d) all Support Obligations of
such Person with respect to Debt of others, (e) the principal portion
of all obligations of such Person under Capital Leases, (f) the maximum
amount of all drafts drawn under standby letters of credit issued or
bankers' acceptances facilities created for the account of such Person
(to the extend unreimbursed), and (g) the outstanding attributed
principal amount under any asset securitization program of such Person.
The Debt of any Person shall include the Debt of any partnership or
joint venture in which such Person is a general partner or a joint
venturer, but only to the extent to which there is recourse to such
Person for payment of such Debt.
-5-
<PAGE>
"Default" means any event or circumstance which, with the
giving of notice, the lapse of time, or both, would (if not cured or
otherwise remedied) constitute an Event of Default.
"Dollar Equivalent" means (a) in relation to an amount
denominated in Dollars, the amount thereof and (b) in relation to an
amount denominated in any Approved Currency other than Dollars, the
amount of Dollars that can be purchased with such Approved Currency at
the spot rate of exchange determined by the Bank in accordance with its
customary practices on the date of determination.
"Dollars", "dollars" and "$" each mean lawful money of the
United States.
"Effective Date" means the date on which all conditions
precedent set forth in Section 5.01 are satisfied or waived by the
Bank.
Environmental Laws" means any and all federal, state, local
and foreign statutes, laws, regulations, ordinances, rules, judgements,
orders, decrees, permits, licenses, agreements or other governmental
restrictions relating to the environment or to emissions, discharges or
releases of pollutants, contaminants, petroleum products, or toxic or
hazardous substances or wastes into the environment, including ambient
air, surface water, groundwater, or land, or otherwise relating to the
manufacture, processing, distribution, use, treatment, storage,
disposal, transport or handling of pollutants, contaminants, petroleum
or petroleum products, or toxic or hazardous substances or wastes or
the clean-up or other remediation thereof.
"ERISA" means the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of
1974, as amended.
"ERISA Affiliate" means any entity or trade or business,
whether or not incorporated, that, together with any Borrower, is
treated as a single employer under Section 414 of the Code.
"Event of Default" means any of the events or circumstances
specified in Section 8.01.
"Federal Funds Rate" means, for any day, the rate set forth in
the weekly statistical release designated as H.15(519), or any
successor publication, published by the Federal Reserve Board
(including any such successor, "H.15(519)") for such day opposite the
caption "Federal Funds (Effective)". If on any relevant day such rate
is not yet published in H.15(519), the rate for such day will be the
rate set forth in the daily statistical release designated as the
Composite 3:30 p.m. Quotations for U.S. Government Securities, or any
successor publication, published by the Federal Reserve Bank of New
York (including any such successor, the "Composite 3:30 p.m.
Quotation") for such day
-6-
<PAGE>
under the caption "Federal Funds Effective
Rate". If on any relevant day the appropriate rate for such previous
day is not yet published in either H.15(519) or the Composite 3:30 p.m.
Quotations, the rate for such day will be the arithmetic mean of the
rates for the last transaction in overnight Federal funds arranged
prior to 9:00 a.m. (New York time) on that day by each of three leading
brokers of Federal funds transactions in New York City selected by the
Bank.
"Federal Reserve Board" means the Board of Governors of the
Federal Reserve System or any successor thereof.
"Financial Letter of Credit" has the meaning assigned thereto
in Section 3.01(a).
"Fiscal Year" means the fiscal year of Pittston ending on
December 31 in any year.
"Foreign Pension Plan" means any plan, fund (including,
without limitation, any superannuation fund) or other similar program
established or maintained outside the United States of America by
Pittston or any one or more of its Subsidiaries primarily for the
benefit of employees of Pittston or such Subsidiaries residing outside
the United States of America, which plan, fund or other similar program
provides, or results in, retirement income, a deferral of income in
contemplation of retirement or payments to be made upon termination of
employment, and which plan is not subject to ERISA or the Code.
"GAAP" means generally accepted accounting principles in the
United States, as recognized by the American Institute of Certified
Public Accountants and the Financial Accounting Standards Board,
consistently applied and maintained on a consistent basis throughout
the period indicated, subject to Section 1.02(a).
"Governmental Authority" means any nation or government, any
state or other political subdivision thereof, any central bank (or
similar monetary or regulatory authority) thereof, any entity
exercising executive, legislative, judicial, regulatory or
administrative functions of or pertaining to government, and any
corporation or other entity owned or controlled, through stock or
capital ownership or otherwise, by any of the foregoing.
"Guaranties" mean the Guaranty of Pittston, substantially in
the form of Exhibit A-1 hereto, the Guaranty of BAX, substantially in
the form of Exhibit A-2 hereto, and the Guaranty of Brink's,
substantially in the form of Exhibit A-3 hereto.
"Hedging Agreements" means interest rate protection
agreements, foreign currency exchange agreements, other interest or
exchange rate hedging, cap or collar arrangements or arrangements
designed to protect the Guarantor or any of its Subsidiaries against
fluctuations in the prices of commodities.
-7-
<PAGE>
"Insolvency Proceeding" means (a) any case, action or
proceeding before any court or other Governmental Authority relating to
bankruptcy, reorganization, insolvency, liquidation, receivership,
dissolution, winding-up or relief of debtors, or (b) any general
assignment for the benefit of creditors, composition, marshaling of
assets for creditors or other, similar arrangement in respect of its
creditors generally or any substantial portion of its creditors; and,
in each case, undertaken under United States federal or State or
foreign law, including the Bankruptcy Code.
"Interest Coverage Ratio" means, as of the last day of any
fiscal quarter, the ratio of (a) Consolidated EBITDA to (b)
Consolidated Interest Expense, in each case for the period of four (4)
consecutive fiscal quarters ending as of such day.
"Interest Payment Date" means (i) the Termination Date , (ii)
with respect to LIBOR Rate Loans, the last day of the Interest Period
applicable to each such Loan, and, if any such Interest Period exceeds
three months, interest shall also be paid on the date which falls three
months after the beginning of such Interest Period, and (iii) with
respect to Base Rate Loans, the last Business Day of each calendar
quarter.
"Interest Period" means, with respect to any LIBOR Rate Loan,
the period commencing on the Business Day such Loan is disbursed,
continued or converted to a Base Rate Loan, and in each case ending on
the date one, two, three or six months thereafter, as selected by the
relevant Borrower in its notice of borrowing or notice of conversion or
continuation, provided that:
(i) if any Interest Period would otherwise end on a day which is not a
Business Day, that Interest Period shall be extended to the next succeeding
Business Day unless the result of such extension would be to carry such Interest
Period into another calendar month, in which event such Interest Period shall
end on the immediately preceding Business Day;
(ii) any Interest Period that begins on the last Business Day of a calendar
month (or on a day for which there is no numerically corresponding day in the
calendar month at the end of such Interest Period) shall end on the last
Business Day of the calendar month at the end of such Interest Period; and
(iii) no Interest Period for any Loan shall extend beyond the Termination
Date.
"Labor Laws" means any and all federal, state, local and
foreign statutes, laws, regulations, ordinances, rules, judgements and
orders relating to employment, equal employment opportunity,
nondiscrimination, immigration, wages, hours, benefits, collective
bargaining, the payment of social security and similar taxes,
occupational safety and health, and plant closing.
-8-
<PAGE>
"L/C Application" has the meaning assigned thereto in Section
3.03(b).
Section 3.05(a). "Lease" means a lease, other than a Capital
Lease, of real or personal property.
"Lease Rentals" for any period means the sum of the rental and
other obligations to be paid by the lessee under a Lease during the
remaining term of such Lease (excluding any extension or renewal
thereof at the option of the lessor or the lessee unless such option
has been exercised), excluding any amount required to be paid by the
lessee (whether or not therein designated as rental or additional
rental) on account of maintenance and repairs, insurance, taxes,
assessments, water rates and similar charges.
"Lending Office" shall mean the particular Chicago office of
the Bank for Base Rate Loans, Letters of Credit or for LIBOR Rate Loans
at its respective address set forth on Schedule 9.02 hereto.
"Letter of Credit" means any stand-by letter of credit issued
by a Lending Office pursuant to Section 3.03 and may be a Financial
Letter of Credit or a Performance Letter of Credit.
"Letter of Credit Obligations" means, in respect of any Letter
of Credit as at any date of determination, the sum of (a) the maximum
aggregate amount which is then available to be drawn under such Letter
of Credit plus (b) the aggregate amount of all Reimbursement
Obligations then outstanding with respect to such Letter of Credit.
"Leverage Ratio" means, as of the date of any determination,
the ratio of (a) the sum of (i) Consolidated Debt as of such date, plus
(ii) the amount by which (A) the aggregate amount, as of the preceding
December 31 (or as of such date if such date is December 31), of
Consolidated Lease Rentals under non-cancelable Leases entered into by
Pittston or any of its Subsidiaries, discounted to present value at 10%
and net of aggregate minimum non-cancelable sublease rentals,
determined on a basis consistent with Note 12 to Pittston's
consolidated financial statements at and for the period ended December
31, 2001, included in Pittston's 2001 Annual Report to shareholders,
exceeds (B) $350,000,000, to (b) the sum of (i) the amount determined
pursuant to clause (a), plus (ii) Consolidated Net Worth as of such
date.
"LIBOR Rate" means, for each Interest Period in respect of any
LIBOR Rate Loan:
(a) the rate per annum (carried out to the fifth
decimal place) equal to the rate determined by the relevant
Lending Office to be the offered rate that appears on the page
of the Telerate Screen that displays an average British
Bankers
-9-
<PAGE>
Association Interest Settlement Rate (such page
currently being page number 3750) for deposits in dollars (for
delivery on the first day of such Interest Period) with a term
equivalent to such Interest Period, determined as of
approximately 11:00 a.m. (London time) two Business Days prior
to the first day of such Interest Period, or
(b) in the event the rate referenced in the preceding
subsection (a) does not appear on such page or service or such
page or service shall cease to be available, the rate per
annum (carried to the fifth decimal place) equal to the rate
determined by the Bank to be the offered rate on such other
page or other service that displays an average British Bankers
Association Interest Settlement Rate for deposits in dollars
(for delivery on the first day of such Interest Period) with a
term equivalent to such Interest Period, determined as of
approximately 11:00 a.m. (London time) two Business Days prior
to the first day of such Interest Period, or
(c) in the event the rates referenced in the
preceding subsections (a) and (b) are not available, the rate
per annum determined by the Bank as the rate of interest at
which dollar deposits (for delivery on the first day of such
Interest Period) in same day funds in the approximate amount
of the applicable LIBOR Rate Loan and with a term equivalent
to such Interest Period would be offered by the Bank's London
Branch to major banks in the offshore dollar market at their
request at approximately 11:00 a.m. (London time) two Business
Days prior to the first day of such Interest Period.
"LIBOR Rate Loan" means a Loan that bears interest based on
the LIBOR Rate.
"Lien" means, with respect to any asset, any mortgage, lien,
pledge, charge, security interest or encumbrance of any kind in respect
of such asset. For the purposes of this Agreement, a Person shall be
deemed to own subject to a Lien any asset which it has acquired or
holds subject to the interest of a vendor or lessor under any
conditional sale agreement, Capital Lease or other title retention
agreement relating to such asset.
"Loan" means an advance of funds by a Lending Office to a
Borrower pursuant to Section 2.03, and may be a Base Rate Loan or a
LIBOR Rate Loan.
"Loan Documents" means this Agreement and all documents
delivered to the Bank or any other Lending Office in connection
herewith, including without limitation, the Notes, the Guaranty, any
L/C Related Documents and any other documentation executed at the
request of any Lending Office.
"Long Term Debt" of any Person means all Debt which would, in
accordance with GAAP, be classified upon its balance sheet as long term
debt, excluding any portion thereof which would, in accordance with
GAAP, be classified thereon as a current
-10-
<PAGE>
liability, and in any event
includes (a) any obligation for borrowed money outstanding under a
revolving credit or similar agreement providing for borrowing (and
renewals and extensions thereof) over a period of more than one year
after the creation of such agreement notwithstanding that any
obligation thereunder may be payable on demand or within one year after
the creation thereof, (b) any Capital Lease Obligation and 8 any
guarantee or equivalent or similar obligation under any agreement
specified in subsection (a) of the definition of Debt with respect to
Debt of another Person of the kind otherwise described in this
definition.
"Margin" means the applicable percentage set forth below based
upon the higher of the S&P Rating or the Moody's Rating on the last day
of the calendar quarter, or other due date, with respect to which
interest is being calculated, provided, that if on any such date the
S&P Rating and the Moody's Rating do not fall into contiguous columns
under the following grid, then the applicable percentage set forth
below based upon the lower of the S&P Rating or the Moody's Rating (but
no lower than the applicable percentage in the column contiguous with
the higher of the S&P Rating or the Moody's Rating) shall be used:
<TABLE>
- ----------------- ----------- ------------- ------------- --------------- --------------- --------------
<S> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C>
bla 0 0 0 0 0 0
S&P
A- BBB+ BBB BBB- BB+ Below BB+
Rating
- ---------------- or higher
----------- ------------- ------------- --------------- --------------- --------------
Moody's
Rating A3 Baa1 Baa2 Baa3 Ba1 Below Ba1
or higher
- ---------------- ------------- ------------- --------------- --------------- ------------- --------------
Margin 0.625% 0.875% 1.125% 1.375% 1.625% 1.875%
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
</TABLE>
If the rating system used to ascribe either the S&P Rating or
the Moody's Rating shall change prior to the Termination Date, the
Borrowers and the Bank shall negotiate in good faith to amend the
references to specific ratings in this definition to reflect such
changed rating system.
"Margin Stock" shall have the meaning given such term in
Regulation U promulgated by the Federal Reserve Board.
"Material Adverse Effect" means a material adverse change in,
or a material adverse effect upon the financial condition or results of
operations of Pittston and its Subsidiaries taken as a whole that would
impair the Borrowers' and Pittston's ability to perform their
respective obligations under this Agreement and the Guaranties.
-11-
<PAGE>
"Material Domestic Subsidiary" means any Subsidiary of
Pittston which (a) is organized under the laws of the United States,
any state thereof or the District of Columbia and (b) together with its
Subsidiaries, (i) owns more than twenty percent (20%) of Consolidated
Total Assets or (ii) accounts for more than twenty percent (20%) of
Consolidated EBITDA.
"Multiemployer Plan" shall mean a Multiemployer plan within
the meaning of Section 4001(a) (3) of ERISA to which any Borrower or
any ERISA Affiliate is making, has made, is accruing or has accrued an
obligation to make, contributions within the preceding six years.
"Moody's Rating" means the rating ascribed by Moody's
Investors Service, Inc. to the Guarantor's unsecured, non
credit-enhanced long-term debt for borrowed money (whether
senior or subordinated).
"Note" means any promissory note executed by a Borrower in
favor of the Bank or any other Lending Office pursuant to Section
2.01(e).
"Obligations" means all Loans, Letter of Credit Obligations
and other indebtedness, advances, Debts, liabilities, obligations,
covenants and duties owing by a Borrower to the Bank, any Lending
Office or any other Person required to be indemnified by that Borrower
under any Loan Document, of any kind or nature, present or future,
whether or not evidenced by any note, guaranty or other instrument,
arising under this Agreement, under any other Loan Document, whether
arising under, out of, or in connection with, any checks, notes,
drafts, bills of exchange, acceptances, orders, instruments of
guarantee and indemnity or other instruments for the payment of money,
or in any other manner and also including any other document made,
delivered or given in connection therewith, and each other obligation
and liability, whether direct or indirect, absolute or contingent, due
or to become due, or now existing or hereafter incurred, of any
Borrower to the Bank or any other Lending Office arising under any Loan
Document, whether on account of principal, interest, reimbursement
obligations, fees, indemnities, costs, expenses (including, without
limitation, all fees and disbursements of counsel to the Bank,
including, without limitation, allocated costs of staff counsel) or
otherwise, whether or not for the payment of money, whether arising by
reason of an extension of credit, loan, guaranty, indemnification or in
any other manner, whether direct or indirect (including those acquired
by assignment), absolute or contingent, due or to become due, now
existing or hereafter arising and however acquired.
"PBGC" shall mean the Pension Benefit Guaranty Corporation and
any entity succeeding to any or all of its functions under ERISA.
"Pension Plan" means any employee pension benefit plan (within
the meaning of Section 3(2) of ERISA), other than a Multiemployer Plan,
which is subject to the
-12-
<PAGE>
provisions of Title IV of ERISA or Section 412
of the Code and is maintained for the employees of Pittston or any of
its ERISA Affiliates.
"Person" means an individual, partnership, limited liability
company, corporation, business trust, joint stock company, trust,
unincorporated association, joint venture or Governmental Authority.
"Pittston Credit Agreement" means that certain $350,000,000
Credit Agreement, dated as of September 6, 2002, among Pittston (as
borrower), certain of its subsidiaries, as guarantors, the lenders
party thereto, and JPMorganChase, as administrative agent, as it may be
amended, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time
hereafter.
"Pittston Minerals Group" means Pittston Minerals Group, Inc.,
and its Subsidiaries.
"Plan" shall mean a pension plan within the meaning of Section
3 (2) of ERISA subject to Title IV of ERISA which any Borrower or any
ERISA Affiliate maintains or to which any Borrower or any ERISA
Affiliate contributes other than a Multiemployer Plan.
"Reimbursement Obligation" means in respect of any Letter of
Credit at any date of determination, the aggregate amount of all
drawings under such Letter of Credit honored by the issuing Lending
Office and not theretofore reimbursed by the relevant Borrower or by
the Guarantor.
"Reportable Event" shall have the meaning attributed thereto
in Section 4043 of ERISA but shall not include any event for which the
30-30 requirement in Section 4043 of ERISA has been waived under
regulations of the PBGC.
"Requirement of Law" means, as to any Person, any law
(statutory or common), treaty, rule or regulation or determination of a
court or an arbitrator or of a Governmental Authority, in each case
applicable to or binding upon the Person or any of its property or to
which the Person or any of its property is subject.
"Responsible Officer" means the chief executive officer,
president, chief financial officer or treasurer of a Borrower or the
Guarantor, or any other officer having substantially the same authority
and responsibility.
"Restricted Subsidiary" means:
(i) any Subsidiary of Pittston at the date of this Agreement other than a
Subsidiary designated as an Unrestricted Subsidiary in Schedule 1.1(b) to the
Pittston Credit Agreement;
(ii) any Material Domestic Subsidiary of the Borrower;
-13-
<PAGE>
(iii) any Subsidiary of Pittston that is a Guarantor;
(iv) any Subsidiary of Pittston that owns, directly or indirectly, any of
the capital stock of any Guarantor; and
(v) any Person that becomes a Subsidiary of Pittston
after the date hereof unless prior to such Person becoming a Subsidiary
the board of directors of Pittston designates such Subsidiary as an
Unrestricted Subsidiary, in accordance with the following paragraph.
A Restricted Subsidiary (other than any Material Domestic Subsidiary,
any Subsidiary that is a Guarantor or any Subsidiary that owns,
directly or indirectly, any of the capital stock of any Guarantor) may
be designated by the board of directors of Pittston as an Unrestricted
Subsidiary by written notice to the Bank, but only if (a) the
Subsidiary owns no shares, directly or indirectly, of Pittston or any
Restricted Subsidiary and (b) immediately after such designation, the
Leverage Ratio is not greater than 0.55 to 1.00 and the Interest
Coverage Ratio is at least 3.00 to 1.00. An Unrestricted Subsidiary may
be designated by the board of directors of Pittston as a Restricted
Subsidiary by written notice to the Bank, but only if immediately after
such designation (x) the Borrower shall be in compliance with Section
7.02(b) and (y) the Leverage Ratio is not greater than 0.55 to 1.00 and
the Interest Coverage Ratio is at least 3.00 to 1.00.
"Sale and Leaseback Transaction" means the sale by Pittston or
a Restricted Subsidiary to any Person (other than the Borrowers) of any
property or asset and, as part of the same transaction or series of
transactions, the leasing as lessee by Pittston or any Restricted
Subsidiary of the same or another property or asset which it intends to
use for substantially the same purpose.
"S&P Rating" means the rating ascribed by Standard & Poor's
Corporation to the Guarantor's unsecured, non credit-enhanced long-term
debt for borrowed money (whether senior or subordinated).
"Subsidiary" means, with respect to any Person (the "parent")
at any date, any corporation, limited liability company, partnership,
association or other entity the accounts of which would be consolidated
with those of the parent in the parent's consolidated financial
statements if such financial statements were prepared in accordance
with GAAP as of such date, as well as any other corporation, limited
liability company, partnership, association or other entity (a) of
which securities or other ownership interests representing more than
fifty percent (50%) of the equity or more than fifty percent (50%) of
the ordinary voting power or, in the case of a partnership, more than
fifty percent (50%) of the general partnership interests are, as of
such date, owned, controlled or held, or (b) that is, as of such date,
otherwise controlled, by the parent or one or more subsidiaries of the
-14-
<PAGE>
parent or by the parent and one or more subsidiaries of the parent.
Unless otherwise qualified, references to "Subsidiary" or
"Subsidiaries" herein shall refer to those of Pittston.
"Support Obligation" means, with respect to any person, at any
date without duplication, any Debt of another Person that is
guaranteed, directly or indirectly in any manner, by such Person or
endorsed (otherwise than for collection or deposit in the ordinary
course of business) or discounted with recourse by such Person or any
Debt of another Person that has the substantially equivalent or similar
economic effect of being guaranteed by such Person or of otherwise
making such Person contingently liable therefor, through an agreement
or otherwise, including, without limitation, an agreement (i) to
purchase, or to advance or supply funds for the payment or purchase of,
such Debt, or (ii) to make any loan, advance, capital contribution or
other investment in such other Person to assure a minimum equity, asset
base, working capital or other balance sheet condition for any date, or
to provide funds for the payment of any liability, dividend or stock
liquidation payment, or otherwise to supply funds to or in any manner
invest in such other Person (unless such investment is expected to
constitute a permitted investment under Section 7.02(j)).
"Taxes" has the meaning assigned thereto in Section 4.01(a).
"Termination Date" has the meaning assigned thereto in Section 2.01.
"United States" and "U.S." each means the United States of America.
"Unrestricted Subsidiary" means any Subsidiary other than a Restricted
Subsidiary.
"Withholding Taxes" has the meaning assigned thereto in Section 4.01(a).
1.02 Accounting Principles.02 Accounting Principles.02 Accounting
Principles.02 Accounting Principles. Except as otherwise expressly provided
herein, all accounting terms used herein shall be interpreted, and all financial
statements and certificates and reports as to financial matters required to be
delivered to the Bank hereunder shall be prepared, in accordance with GAAP
applied on a consistent basis. All calculations made for the purposes of
determining compliance with this Agreement shall (except as otherwise expressly
provided herein) be made by application of GAAP applied on a basis consistent
with the most recent annual or quarterly financial statements delivered pursuant
to Section 7.03, consistent with the annual audited financial statements
referenced in Section 6.07); provided, however, if (a) the Borrower shall object
to determining such compliance on such basis at the time of delivery of such
financial statements due to any change in GAAP or the rules promulgated with
respect thereto or (b) the Bank shall so object in writing within 60 days after
delivery of such financial statements, then such calculations shall be made on a
basis consistent with the most recent financial statements delivered by Pittston
to the Bank as to which no such objection shall have been made.
-15-
<PAGE>
ARTICLE
LOANS AND ALLOCATIONS
2.01 Amounts and Terms of Commitment.01 Amounts and Terms of
Commitment.01 Amounts and Terms of Commitment.01 Amounts and Terms of
Commitment. Bank agrees to make available to the Borrowers, including Pittston,
from the Effective Date until December 20, 2005 or until such earlier date on
which the Bank terminates the Commitment pursuant to Section 8.02(a) or BAX,
Brink's and Pittston terminate the Commitment pursuant to Section 2.05(a) (the
"Termination Date"), committed funds in an aggregate amount of $45,000,000
(subject to reduction pursuant to Section 2.05(a) and Section 7.01) on the terms
and conditions set forth in this Agreement, as follows:
(a) Facility Advances(a) Facility Advances(a) Facility
Advances(a) Facility Advances. The Facility may be drawn upon by the
Borrowers for Loans or Letters of Credit (collectively, "Advances")
from the Effective Date until the Termination Date in an aggregate
principal amount not to exceed $45,000,000 (subject to reduction
pursuant to Section 2.05(a)) at any time outstanding.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(b) Facility Allocations
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(i) The initial allocations of the Commitment among
the Covered Subsidiaries on Schedule B-1 attached hereto in the amounts
set forth thereon. The allocation of a portion of the Commitment to a
Covered Subsidiary shall not affect the availability to the Borrowers
of any unused and unallocated portion of the Commitment.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(ii) At any time and from time to time after the
Effective Date, BAX and Brink's may by written notice to the Bank
request the amendment of Schedule B-1 to modify the allocation of the
Commitment among the Borrowers and Covered Subsidiaries, as Schedule
B-1 may be amended or supplemented by the Borrowers from time to time.
Any such request shall state the name and address of the relevant
Subsidiary and the country in which a credit extension is contemplated.
The Bank, after consultation with the relevant branch or Affiliate,
shall notify the requesting Borrower as soon as reasonably practicable
whether it accepts such re-allocation and shall advise the Borrowers in
writing of the amount of such re-allocation. The Bank shall not be
obligated in any way to accept any requested amendment to Schedule B-1.
The determination by the Bank of the Dollar Equivalent with respect to
any credit extensions in a currency other than US Dollars shall be
conclusive and binding upon the Borrowers; the Bank may readjust the
Dollar Equivalent periodically as provided in Section 2.04 (b) and
Section 2.06(b)(provided it agrees not to make any such readjustment
unless the Dollar Equivalent of Loans, Letter of Credit Obligations and
allocations exceeds the Commitment by 3% or more and the Bank agrees to
give the Borrowers prompt written notice of any such readjustment). The
Bank's relevant branch or Affiliate and the relevant Covered Subsidiary
shall be free to structure each individual credit transaction in
accordance with all relevant law, local custom and practice, including
pricing and collateral, provided the Guaranties of the relevant
Guarantors shall apply to all such
-16-
<PAGE>
extensions of credit. Any portions
of the Commitment allocated as hereinabove provided shall be
unavailable for use by any of the Borrowers and for further allocation
until such time as the Bank notifies the Borrowers of reinstated
availability. The Bank shall be entitled to demand cash collateral from
the relevant Guarantor with respect to the principal of any obligations
of any Covered Subsidiaries (but not with respect to interest, fees and
the like with respect to any such obligations) incurred in respect to
credit extensions contemplated by this Agreement which the Bank
reasonably determines may be outstanding beyond the Termination Date or
outstanding after any such Covered Subsidiary ceases to qualify as a
Subsidiary (in the latter case, the providing of cash collateral shall
not be required until 30 days after the Bank so requests). Cash
collateral shall be by means of a deposit of immediately available
funds in an amount equal to the aggregate principal amount of any such
obligations in a non-interest bearing account with the Bank. Any
failure to provide cash collateral in accordance with this Section
2.01(b)(ii) shall, upon written notice from the Bank, be an Event of
Default hereunder.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<PAGE>
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- 53 -
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(c) Documentation for LoansDocumentation for
LoansDocumentation for LoansDocumentation for Loans. Each Loan may be
evidenced by (a) one or more master promissory notes in form and
substance acceptable to the relevant Lending Office or (b) by loan
accounts maintained by such Lending Office. The records attached as
grids to the promissory notes and the loan account and account records
shall be conclusive evidence, absent manifest error, of the amount of
the Loans and the interest and payments thereon. Any failure to record
or any error in doing so shall not, however, increase, limit or
otherwise affect the obligation hereunder of any Borrower to pay any
amount owing with respect to the Loans.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
2.02 Procedure for Incurring Loans.02 Procedure for Incurring Loans.02
Procedure for Incurring Loans.02 Procedure for Incurring Loans. Each Loan shall
be made upon the request of a Borrower to the relevant Lending Office (which
request must be received by such Lending Office not later than 11:00 a.m. (local
time), unless otherwise agreed by such Lending Office, (a) on the requested
borrowing date, in the case of Base Rate Loans, and (b) three Business Days
prior to the requested borrowing date, in the case of LIBOR Rate Loans,
specifying (i) the principal amount of the Loan, (ii) the requested borrowing
date, which shall be a Business Day; (iii) whether the Loan is to be a Base Rate
Loan or a LIBOR Rate Loan; and (iv) if the requested Loan is a LIBOR Rate Loan,
the duration of the Interest Period applicable to such Loan. If the notice of
borrowing shall fail to specify the duration of the Interest Period for any
LIBOR Rate Loan, such Interest Period shall be one month.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
2.03 Conversion and Continuation Elections with Respect to Outstanding
Loans.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(a) Any Borrower may upon irrevocable written notice to the
applicable Lending Office in accordance with Section 2.03(b):
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(i) elect to convert, on any Business Day, any Base Rate Loan
made to such Borrower into a LIBOR Rate Loan; or
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(ii) elect to convert, on the last day of any Interest Period
therefor, any LIBOR Rate Loan made to such Borrower into a
Base Rate Loan; or
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(iii) elect, on the last day of the Interest Period with
respect to any LIBOR Rate Loan made to such Person, to
continue such Loan as a LIBOR Rate Loan denominated in the
same currency for an additional Interest Period.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(b) Any Borrower wishing to convert or continue a Loan as
described in Section 2.03(a) shall deliver by fax, a notice of
conversion or continuation (which notice must be received by the
applicable Lending Office not later than 11:00 a.m. (local time),
unless otherwise agreed by such Lending Office) (i) on the date of
conversion of a LIBOR Rate Loan into a Base Rate Loan, (ii) four
Business Days prior to the date of conversion of a LIBOR Rate Loan; and
(iii) four Business Days prior to the date of continuation of a LIBOR
Rate Loan, specifying:
- -----------------------------------------------------------------
- -----------------------------------------------------------------
(A) the proposed date of conversion or continuation;
- -----------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(B) the aggregate amount of Loans to be converted or continued;
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(C) the nature of the proposed conversion or continuation; and
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(D) the duration of any requested Interest Period. If
the notice of conversion or continuation shall fail to specify
the duration of the Interest Period for any LIBOR Rate Loan,
such Interest Period shall be one month.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(c) During the existence of a Default or Event of Default,
the Bank may demand that any or all of the then-outstanding LIBOR Rate
Loans be converted upon their expiration into Base Rate Loans. Such
conversion shall continue to be in effect so long as such Default or
Event of Default continues to exist.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
2.04 Termination or Reduction of the Commitment.04 Termination or
Reduction of the Commitment.04 Termination or Reduction of the Commitment.04
Termination or Reduction of the Commitment.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(a) The Borrowers may, upon not less than three Business Days'
prior notice to the Bank (i) terminate the Commitment upon full
prepayment of all outstanding Advances and upon the termination of all
allocations theretofore accepted by the Bank or the providing of cash
collateral in all respects satisfactory to the Bank in order to fully
collateralize the obligations of the Guarantors under the Guaranties or
(ii) permanently reduce the Commitment to an amount not less than the
Dollar Equivalent of the principal amount of all Advances outstanding
on the reduction date and all allocations of Commitment not theretofore
terminated. If the Commitment is terminated in its entirety under this
Section 2.04(a), all accrued and unpaid commitment fees to, but not
including, the effective date of such termination shall be payable on
the effective date of such termination without any premium or penalty.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(b) For the purpose of ensuring compliance with the maximum
amount available under the Commitment, the Bank shall on each date of a
voluntary reduction of the Commitment under Section 2.04(a) and on the
last Business Day of each calendar quarter, determine the Dollar
Equivalent of the principal amount of all existing allocations and
then-outstanding Advances.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
2.05 Optional Prepayments.05 Optional Prepayments.05 Optional
Prepayments.05 Optional Prepayments. Subject to Section 4.04, any Borrower may,
at any time or from time to time, upon at least three Business Days' notice to
the applicable Lending Office, prepay Loans made to it in whole or in part. Such
notice of prepayment shall specify the date and amount of such prepayment and
whether such prepayment is of Base Rate Loans, LIBOR Rate Loans or any
combination thereof. No such notice shall be revocable by any Borrower after
being given. Once such notice is given by any Borrower, such Borrower shall make
such prepayment, and the payment amount specified in such notice shall be due
and payable, on the date specified therein, together (only in the case of
prepayments of LIBOR Rate Loans) with accrued interest to each such date on the
amount prepaid and the amounts, if any, required pursuant to Section 4.04.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
2.06 Repayment of Principa
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(a) Each Borrower shall repay on the Termination Date the
principal amount of the Loans made to it.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(b) In the event that the Bank determines, based on its
computation made in accordance with Section 2.04(b) or at any other
time that the Dollar Equivalent of the then-outstanding Loans, Letter
of Credit Obligations and allocations exceeds the Commitment, the Bank
shall give notice to the Borrowers of such fact and of the amount of
such excess (provided that the Bank agrees that no such notice shall be
given unless the Dollar Equivalent of the Loans, Letter of Credit
Obligations and allocations exceeds the Commitment by 3% or more).
Within 30 days after the date on which the Borrowers receive such
notice, they shall prepay Loans or collateralize the Letter of Credit
Obligations or allocations with cash (as set forth below), in the
aggregate amount of such excess. Any such prepayment of LIBOR Rate
Loans shall be made together with interest on the principal amount
thereof and any amount required to be paid in connection therewith
pursuant to Section 4.04. Any prepayments pursuant to this Section
2.06(b) shall be applied, first, to any Base Rate Loans then
outstanding, second, to LIBOR Rate Loans having Interest Periods ending
on the date of such prepayment, and third, to the extent that the
amounts referred to in clauses "first" and "second" are not sufficient
to satisfy the entire prepayment requirement under this Section 2.06(b)
or there are no such Loans outstanding on the date such prepayment
would be required, then the remaining amount that would be required to
be prepaid under this Section 2.06(b) shall be deposited in a cash
collateral account maintained by the Bank, to be held as security for
the Obligations hereunder pursuant to a cash collateral agreement to be
entered into in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Bank
and the Borrowers, and to be applied to the prepayment of LIBOR Rate
Loans at the end of the respective Interest Periods therefor and to the
payment of Reimbursement Obligations as the same become due.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
2.07 Interest.07 Interest.07 Interest.07 Interest.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(a) Subject to Section 2.07(c), each Loan made by the Bank
shall bear interest on the outstanding principal amount thereof from
the date when made until it becomes due at a rate per annum equal to
the LIBOR Rate plus the applicable Margin or the Base Rate per annum.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(b) Interest on each Loan shall be payable in arrears on each
Interest Payment Date. Interest shall also be payable on the date of
any prepayment of LIBOR Rate Loans pursuant to Section 2.05 for the
portion of such Loans so prepaid and upon payment (including
prepayment) in full of LIBOR Rate Loans; provided, however, that
interest payable pursuant to Section 2.07(c) shall be payable on
demand.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(c) While there shall be any default hereunder in the payment
of principal, interest, fees or any other amount owing hereunder or
after acceleration, each Borrower shall pay interest (after as well as
before entry of judgment thereon to the extent permitted by law) on the
principal amount of all Obligations of such Person that are due and
unpaid, at a rate per annum determined by adding 2% per annum to the
interest rate then in effect for the applicable type of Loan and in the
case of Obligations other than Loans, at a rate per annum equal to the
Base Rate plus 2%; provided, however, that, on and after the expiration
of any Interest Period applicable to any LIBOR Rate Loan outstanding on
the date of occurrence of such Event of Default or acceleration, the
principal amount of such Loan shall, during the continuation of such
Event of Default or after acceleration, bear interest at a rate per
annum equal to the Base Rate plus 2%.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(d) Anything herein to the contrary notwithstanding, the
obligations of the Borrowers hereunder shall be subject to the
limitation that payments of interest shall not be required, for any
period for which interest is computed hereunder, to the extent (but
only to the extent) that contracting for or receiving such payment by
the relevant Lending Office would be contrary to the provisions of any
applicable law limiting the highest rate of interest which may be
lawfully contracted for, charged or received by the relevant Lending
Office, and in such event the Borrowers shall pay the relevant Lending
Office interest at the highest rate permitted by applicable law.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
2.08 Fees.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(a) Commitment Fee(a) Commitment Fee(a) Commitment Fee(a)
Commitment Fee. Pittston shall pay to the Bank a commitment fee in
Dollars computed at a rate per annum equal to the Commitment Fee Rate
on the average daily unused and unallocated portion of the Commitment,
computed on a quarterly basis in arrears on the last day of each
calendar quarter. Such commitment fees shall accrue from the Effective
Date to the Termination Date and shall be due and payable quarterly in
arrears on the fifth Business Day following receipt of an invoice from
the Bank, with the final payment to be made on the Termination Date.
The commitment fee shall accrue at all times after the Effective Date,
including at any time during which one or more conditions in Article V
are not met. For purposes of computing utilization and allocations of
the Commitment, the Dollar Equivalent of any outstanding amount that is
not denominated in Dollars shall be determined as of the last day of
each calendar quarter.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(b) Letter of Credit Fees
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(i) Each Borrower shall pay to the Bank a letter of
credit fee equal to (A) in the case of a Performance Letter of
Credit issued by the Bank for the account of such Borrower, an
amount equal to one half of the Margin per annum on the amount
from time to time available to be drawn under such Performance
Letter of Credit, and (B) in the case of a Financial Letter of
Credit issued by the Bank for the account of such Borrower,
equal to the Margin per annum on the amount from time to time
available to be drawn under such Financial Letter of Credit.
Such fee shall accrue on such amount from the date of issuance
of each Letter of Credit (with such issuance date being deemed
to be the Effective Date in the case of the Outstanding
Letters of Credit that are to be continued hereunder as
Performance Letters of Credit or Financial Letters of Credit)
until its expiration date, taking into account any extensions
of the expiration date beyond the initial expiration date.
Such fee shall be payable quarterly in arrears on the last day
of each calendar quarter and on the date each Letter of Credit
expires or is fully drawn.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(ii) In addition to the letter of credit fees due the
Bank hereunder, each Borrower shall pay to any Lending Office
issuing a Letter of Credit any standard amendment, negotiation
or other fees as such Lending Office may request at the time
such Letter of Credit is issued or amended.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(c) Arrangement Fee. The Borrowers shall pay
to the Bank an arrangement fee in the amount of $115,000 on the
Effective Date.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(d) Administrative Fee. In the event the Bank permits
Obligations of any of the Guarantors to be cash collateralized as
contemplated in Section 2.01(b) or to permit any Letter of Credit to
expire after the Termination Date as contemplated in Section 3.02(b),
the Bank may in its discretion notify Pittston in writing that it
elects to collect an administrative fee of up to $5000 for each such
collateralized Obligation and each extension of a Letter of Credit
beyond the Termination Date. All such administrative fees shall be
payable upon demand and prior to the Bank's acceptance of cash
collateral or any such extension.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
2.09 Computation of Fees and Interest.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(a) All computations of interest payable in respect of Base
Rate Loans at all times as the Base Rate is determined by the Bank's
"reference" or "prime" rate shall be made on the basis of a year of 365
or 366 days, as the case may be, and actual days elapsed. All other
computations of fees and interest under this Agreement shall be made on
the basis of a 360-day year and actual days elapsed. Interest and fees
shall accrue during each period during which interest or such fees are
computed from and including the first day thereof to but excluding the
last day thereof.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(b) Each determination of an interest rate by the Bank
pursuant to any provision of this Agreement shall be conclusive and
binding on the Borrowers in the absence of manifest error.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
2.10 Payments by the Borrowers.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(a) All payments (including prepayments) to be made by any
Borrower on account of Obligations shall be made without set-off or
counterclaim and shall, except as otherwise expressly provided herein,
be made to the relevant Lending Office, in the currency in which the
relevant type of Obligation was denominated and in immediately
available funds, no later than 12:00 noon (local time) unless otherwise
agreed, on the date specified herein. Any payment which is received by
a Lending Office later than 12:00 noon (local time) shall be deemed to
have been received on the immediately succeeding Business Day and any
applicable interest or fee shall continue to accrue.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(b) Whenever any payment hereunder shall be stated to be due
on a day other than a Business Day, such payment shall be made on the
next succeeding Business Day, and such extension of time shall in such
case be included in the computation of interest or fees, as the case
may be, subject to the provisions set forth in the definition of
"Interest Period" herein.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
2.11 Certain Obligations Guaranteed.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
ARTICLE III
LETTERS OF CREDIT
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
3.01 The Letters of Credit Commitment.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(a) Letters of Credit denominated in Dollars or any other
Approved Currency may be issued under the Commitment for the following
purposes: (i) "Financial Letters of Credit" may be issued to any Person
other than an Affiliate to secure the payment by any Person of its
financial obligations, or to provide counter or "back-up" guarantees in
support of bank guarantees, Letters of Credit or other credit
facilities afforded to a Borrower, or to support local currency
borrowings outside the United States, and (ii) "Performance Letters of
Credit" may be issued to secure the performance by any Person of its
obligations, or to guaranty or otherwise secure any Person's
obligations relating to a bid, advance payment or security deposit,
retention release, custom and duty deferment guaranty or bond, warranty
or performance bond or other guaranty and shall include Commercial
Letters of Credit.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(b) The Letter of Credit Obligations set forth on Schedule B-2
hereto are outstanding under the 1999 Revolving Facility. All such
Letter of Credit Obligations shall be deemed outstanding hereunder upon
the Effective Date. With respect to any such Letter of Credit
Obligations that are not Letter of Credit Obligations of a Borrower
hereunder, they shall, upon the effectiveness of this Agreement, become
joint and several obligations of BAX or Brink's, as the case may be,
upon the terms and conditions hereof and as particularly set forth on
Schedule B-2. It is understood and agreed by the Bank and by Brink's
and BAX, respectively, that Brink's shall only be jointly and severally
liable with the entities set opposite its name on Schedule B-2 and that
BAX shall only be jointly and severally liable with the entities set
opposite its name on Schedule B-2; Brink's shall not be jointly and
severally liable with any entity set opposite BAX's name and BAX shall
not be jointly and severally liable with any entity set opposite
Brink's name; nor shall BAX be jointly and severally liable with
Brink's.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
3.02 Terms of the Letters of Credit.02 Terms of the Letters of
Credit.02 Terms of the Letters of Credit.02 Terms of the Letters of Credit.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(a) Performance Letters of Credit issued after the Effective
Date shall not have a term exceeding one year.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(b) No Letter of Credit may expire (including all rights of
renewal) later than the Termination Date, provided, however, that the
Bank in its discretion may elect to, issue Letters of Credit that
expire after the Termination Date, upon terms and conditions acceptable
to the Bank, including without limitation, cash collateral provisions,
it being understood and agreed that this Agreement shall remain in full
force and effect with respect to all such Letters of Credit until they
have expired and all related Letter of Credit Obligations have been
paid in full. Without limiting the generality of the foregoing, the
applicable Borrower will cash collateralize each Letter of Credit that
remains outstanding and undrawn as of the Termination Date by deposit
of immediately available funds in an amount equal to the undrawn amount
of such Letter of Credit in a non-interest-bearing account maintained
with the Bank; provided, however, that subject to the proviso in
Section 8.02, the obligation to so cash collateralize any Letter of
Credit having a stated expiry date occurring after the Termination Date
shall arise only upon the Bank's request to the applicable Borrower. If
any Letter of Credit that is to be cash collateralized is denominated
in an Approved Currency other than Dollars, the amount so deposited
shall, if requested by the Bank, be the Dollar Equivalent of the
undrawn amount of such Letter of Credit as of the Termination Date. The
Bank may, at any time and from time to time after the initial deposit
of cash collateral, require that additional cash collateral be provided
in order to protect against the results of exchange rate fluctuations.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
3.03 Procedure for Issuance of the Letters of Credit.03 Procedure for
Issuance of the Letters of Credit.03 Procedure for Issuance of the Letters of
Credit.03 Procedure for Issuance of the Letters of Credit.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(a) Each Letter of Credit to be issued after the Effective
Date shall be issued upon the request of a Borrower received by the
Bank and any other relevant Lending Office not later than 12:00 noon
(local time), three (3) Business Days prior to the requested date of
issuance.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(b) Each request for issuance of a Letter of Credit shall be
made in writing by fax and confirmed by delivery of the original
executed Letter of Credit Application and Agreement, in the Bank's
standard form or a similar form if the relevant Lending Office uses a
different form (each, an "L/C Application"), not later than one (1)
Business Day thereafter. Each request for issuance of a Letter of
Credit and each L/C Application shall specify, among other things: (i)
the proposed date of issuance (which shall be a Business Day); (ii) the
face amount of the Letter of Credit; (iii) the date of expiration of
the Letter of Credit; (iv) the name and address of the beneficiary
thereof; (v) the documents to be presented by the beneficiary of the
Letter of Credit in case of any drawing thereunder; (vi) the full text
of any certificate to be presented by the beneficiary in case of any
drawing thereunder; and (vii) whether the Letter of Credit is to be a
Financial Letter of Credit or a Performance Letter of Credit.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(c)Any request for an amendment to any previously-issued
Letter of Credit shall be received by the Lending Office which issued
the Letter of Credit not later than 12:00 noon (local time), unless
otherwise agreed by the Lending Office, two (2) Business Days prior to
the date of the proposed amendment in writing by fax. Each written
request for an amendment to a previously-issued Letter of Credit made
by fax shall be in the form of the relevant L/C Application signed by
the relevant Borrower and, unless otherwise agreed by the Lending
Office which issued the Letter of Credit in accordance with the
provisions of Section 3.02(b), shall not request an extension beyond
the relevant Termination Date described in said Section. Amendments and
extensions shall be at the sole discretion of the Lending Office which
issued the Letter of Credit.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(d) Notwithstanding any provision of any L/C Application to
the contrary, in the event of any conflict between the terms of any
such L/C Application and the terms of this Agreement, the terms of this
Agreement shall control with respect to payment obligations, events of
default, representations and warranties, and covenants, except that
such L/C Application may provide for further warranties relating
specifically to the transaction or affairs underlying such Letter of
Credit.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
3.04 Drawings and Reimbursements..04 Drawings and Reimbursements..04
Drawings and Reimbursements..04 Drawings and Reimbursements. Each Borrower
hereby unconditionally and irrevocably agrees to reimburse the relevant Lending
Office for each payment made by such Lending Office under any Letter of Credit
issued for the account of such Borrower; such reimbursement shall be due and
payable on the date the relevant Lending Office makes such payment under such
Letter of Credit. If such reimbursement payment is not made when due, the
Borrower shall be deemed to have timely made a request to the Bank for a Base
Rate Loan on such date in an amount equal to the Dollar Equivalent of the amount
of such draft paid, together with any fees owing to the Bank pursuant to Section
2.08(b) (to the extent such drawn amount and fees, when aggregated with the
principal amount of all other Advances then outstanding and allocations then
existing, do not exceed the Commitment) and, regardless of whether or not the
conditions precedent specified in Article V (except 5.02(c)) have been
satisfied, the Bank shall be deemed to have made a Base Rate Loan in such
amount, the proceeds of which shall be deemed to have satisfied the related
Reimbursement Obligations. Interest shall be payable on any such Base Rate Loan
at the Base Rate.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
3.05 Reimbursement Obligations Absolute.05 Reimbursement Obligations
Absolute.05 Reimbursement Obligations Absolute.05 Reimbursement Obligations
Absolute. The obligations of the Borrowers to reimburse the Lending Office for
payments made by such Lending Office under any Letter of Credit honoring a
demand for payment by the beneficiary thereunder shall be irrevocable, absolute
and unconditional under any and all circumstances, including the following
circumstances:
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(a) any lack of validity or enforceability of this Agreement, any Letter of
Credit, any L/C Application or any other agreement or instrument relating
thereto (collectively, the "L/C Related Documents");
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(b) any change in the time, manner or place of payment of, or in any other
term of, all or any of the obligations of any Borrower in respect of any Letter
of Credit or any other amendment or waiver of or any consent to or departure
from all or any of the L/C Related Documents;
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(c) the existence of any claim, set-off, defense or other right that any
Borrower may have at any time against any beneficiary or any transferee of any
Letter of Credit (or any Person for whom any such beneficiary or any such
transferee may be acting), the Bank, any Lending Office or any other Person,
whether in connection with this Agreement, the transactions contemplated by the
L/C Related Documents or any unrelated transaction;
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(d) any draft, certificate, statement or other document presented under any
Letter of Credit proving to be forged, fraudulent, invalid or insufficient in
any respect or any statement therein being untrue or inaccurate in any respect
other than if such payment resulted from the gross negligence or willful
misconduct of the relevant Lending Office;
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(e) payment by the relevant Lending Office under any Letter of Credit
against presentation of a draft or certificate that does not comply with the
terms of the Letter of Credit other than if such payment resulted from the gross
negligence or willful misconduct of the relevant Lending Office;
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(f) any release or amendment or waiver of or consent to departure from any
guaranty, for all or any of the obligations of any Borrower in respect of any
Letter of Credit; or
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(g) any other circumstance or happening whatsoever, whether or not similar
to any of the foregoing, including any other circumstance that might otherwise
constitute a defense available to, or a discharge of, any Borrower or any
account party other than a circumstance constituting gross negligence or willful
misconduct on the part of the relevant Lending Office.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<PAGE>
ARTICLE IV
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
TAXES, YIELD PROTECTION AND ILLEGALITY
4.01 Taxes.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(a) Payments made hereunder and under any instrument executed
hereunder shall be made free and clear of, and without deduction for,
any and all present or future taxes, levies, imposts, duties,
deductions, withholding and similar charges ("Taxes") excluding, in the
case of the Bank, each Lending Office and each Assignee, Taxes
(including franchise or receipts taxes) imposed on or in respect of its
net income, capital, or receipts, by the jurisdiction (or any political
subdivision thereof) under the laws of which the Bank or such Lending
Office or Assignee (as the case may be) (A) is organized, (B) has its
principal place of business, or (C) is, through an office or other
fixed place of business, deemed to be doing business or maintaining a
permanent establishment under any applicable income tax treaty (such
non-excluded Taxes being "Withholding Taxes"). If any Borrower shall be
required by law to deduct any Withholding Taxes from or in respect of
any sum payable hereunder or under any instrument executed hereunder,
such Borrower:
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(i) shall pay to the Bank, Lending Office or Assignee an additional amount
so that the net amount received and retained by the Bank, Lending Office or
Assignee after taking into account such Withholding Taxes (and any additional
Withholding Taxes payable on account of any additional payment called for by
this sentence) will equal the full amount which would have been received and
retained by the Bank, Lending Office or Assignee as if no such Withholding Taxes
been paid, deducted, or withheld;
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(ii) shall make such deductions; and
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(iii) shall pay the full amount deducted to the relevant taxing authority
or other authority in accordance with applicable law.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(b) Each Borrower will furnish the Bank, Lending Office or
Assignee original Withholding Tax receipts, notarized copies of
Withholding Tax receipts or such other appropriate documentation as
will prove payment of tax in a court of law applying U.S. Federal Rules
of Evidence for all Taxes paid by such Borrower pursuant to Section
4.01(a). The relevant Borrower will deliver such receipts within a
reasonable period after payment of any Withholding Taxes, but in no
event later than 60 days after the due date for the related Withholding
Tax.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(c) If the Bank, Lending Office or Assignee is entitled to a
refund or credit of Withholding Tax, it shall use reasonable efforts to
pursue such refund (and interest with respect thereto), and if it
receives such refund or credit, shall pay to the relevant Borrower the
amount of the refund or credit (and interest with respect thereto)
actually received.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(d) The Bank, Lending Office or Assignee shall use reasonable
efforts (consistent with its internal policies, and legal and
regulatory restrictions) to change the jurisdiction of its relevant
Lending Office if such change would avoid or reduce any Withholding
Tax; provided that no such change of jurisdiction shall be made if, in
the reasonable judgment of the Bank, such Lending Office or such
Assignee, such change would be disadvantageous to the Bank, such
Lending Office or such Assignee, as the case may be.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(e) The Bank agrees that it will deliver to the Borrowers,
within 30 days after the execution of this Agreement (unless
theretofore so delivered) and as may be reasonably required from time
to time by applicable law or regulation, United States Internal Revenue
Service Forms W-8BEN and/or W-8EC1 (or successor Forms) or such other
form, if any, as from time to time may permit the Borrowers to
demonstrate that payments made by the Borrowers to the Bank under this
Agreement either are exempt from United States Federal Withholding
Taxes or are payable at a reduced rate (if any) specified in any
applicable tax treaty or convention.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
4.02 Illegality.02 Illegality.02 Illegality.02 Illegality.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(a) If the Bank shall determine that the introduction of any Requirement of
Law, or any change in any Requirement of Law or in the interpretation or
administration thereof, has made it unlawful, or that any central bank or other
Governmental Authority has asserted that it is unlawful, for the Bank or any
other relevant Lending Office to make LIBOR Rate Loans or to issue Letters of
Credit, then, on notice thereof by the Bank to the Borrowers, the obligation of
the Bank to make LIBOR Rate Loans or to issue Letters of Credit, as the case may
be, shall be suspended until the Bank shall have notified the Borrowers that the
circumstances giving rise to such determination no longer exist.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(b) If the Bank shall determine that it is unlawful to maintain any LIBOR
Rate Loan, the affected Borrowers shall prepay in full all LIBOR Rate Loans then
outstanding, together with interest accrued thereon, either on the last day of
the Interest Period thereof if the Bank may lawfully continue to maintain such
LIBOR Rate Loans to such day, or immediately, if the Bank may not lawfully
continue to maintain such LIBOR Rate Loans, together with any amounts required
to be paid in connection therewith pursuant to Section 4.04.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(c) The Bank shall immediately notify the Borrowers of any event described
in (a) or (b) above.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
4.03 Increased Costs and Reduction of Return; Additional Interest on
LIBOR Rate Loans.03 Increased Costs and Reduction of Return; Additional Interest
on LIBOR Rate Loans.03 Increased Costs and Reduction of Return; Additional
Interest on LIBOR Rate Loans.03 Increased Costs and Reduction of Return;
Additional Interest on LIBOR Rate Loans.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(a) If the Bank shall determine that, due to either (i) the
introduction of any Requirement of Law, or any change in any
Requirement of Law or in the interpretation or administration thereof
or (ii) the compliance with any guideline or request from any central
bank or other Governmental Authority (whether or not having the force
of law), there shall be any increase in the cost to the Bank or any
Lending Office of agreeing to make or making, funding or maintaining
any LIBOR Rate Loans, then the relevant Borrowers shall be liable for,
and shall from time to time, upon written request therefor by the Bank,
pay to the Bank additional amounts as are sufficient to compensate the
Bank or such Lending Office for such increased costs.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(b) If the Bank shall have determined that (i) the
introduction of any Capital Adequacy Regulation, (ii) any change in any
Capital Adequacy Regulation, (iii) any change in the interpretation or
administration of any Capital Adequacy Regulation by any central bank
or other Governmental Authority charged with the interpretation or
administration thereof, or (iv) compliance by the Bank (or other
relevant Lending Office) or any corporation controlling the Bank, with
any Capital Adequacy Regulation affects or would affect the amount of
capital required or expected to be maintained by the Bank, any Lending
Office or any corporation controlling the Bank and (taking into
consideration the Bank's and such controlling corporation's policies
with respect to capital adequacy and the Bank's desired return on
capital) and determines that the amount of such capital is increased as
a consequence of Advances under this Agreement, then, upon written
request of the Bank, the Borrowers shall immediately pay to the Bank or
the relevant Lending Office, from time to time as specified by the
Bank, additional amounts sufficient to compensate the Bank or such
Lending Office for such increase.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(c) Each Borrower shall pay to the Bank, as long as the Bank
shall be required under Federal Reserve Board regulations to maintain
reserves with respect to liabilities or assets consisting of or
including Eurocurrency funds or deposits (currently known as
"Eurocurrency liabilities"), additional costs on the unpaid principal
amount of all LIBOR Rate Loans made by the Bank to such Borrower equal
to the actual costs of such reserves allocated to each such Loan by the
Bank (as determined by the Bank in good faith, which determination
shall be conclusive absent manifest error), payable on each Interest
Payment Date with respect to each such Loan, provided that such
Borrower shall have received at least 15 days' prior written notice of
such additional costs from the Bank. If the Bank fails to give notice
15 days prior to the relevant Interest Payment Date, such additional
interest shall accrue and be payable 15 days from receipt of such
notice.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(d) The Bank will notify each Borrower of any event occurring
after the date hereof which will entitle the Bank or any Lending Office
to compensation from such Borrower pursuant to this Section 4.03 as
promptly as practicable after it obtains knowledge thereof and
determines to request such compensation, and will designate a different
Lending Office if such designation will avoid the need for, or reduce
the amount of, such compensation. If the Bank requests compensation
under this Section 4.03, the relevant Borrowers may, by notice to the
Bank, require that: (x) the Bank furnish to the relevant Borrowers a
statement setting forth the basis for requesting such compensation and
the method for determining the amount thereof or (y) the Loans of the
type with respect to which such compensation is requested be either
prepaid or converted into another type.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
4.04 Funding Losses.04 Funding Losses.04 Funding Losses.04 Funding
Losses. Each Borrower agrees to reimburse the Bank and to hold the Bank and any
relevant Lending Office harmless from any loss or expense which the Bank may
sustain or incur as a consequence of:
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(a) the failure by such Borrower to make any payment or prepayment of
principal of any LIBOR Rate Loan when due (including payments made after any
acceleration thereof);
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(b) the failure by such Borrower to borrow, continue or convert a Loan
after such Borrower has given (or is deemed to have given) a notice of borrowing
or a notice of conversion or continuation;
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(c) the failure by such Borrower to make any prepayment after such Borrower
has given a notice in accordance with Section 2.05;
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(d) the prepayment of a LIBOR Rate Loan on a day which is not the last day
of the Interest Period with respect thereto; or
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(e) the conversion pursuant to Section 2.03 of any LIBOR Rate Loan to a
Base Rate Loan on a day that is not the last day of the Interest Period with
respect to the LIBOR Rate Loan;
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
including any such loss or expense arising from the liquidation or reemployment
of funds obtained by any Lending Office to maintain its LIBOR Rate Loans
hereunder or from fees payable to terminate the deposits from which such funds
were obtained.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
4.05 Inability to Determine Rates.05 Inability to Determine Rates.05
Inability to Determine Rates.05 Inability to Determine Rates. If the Bank shall
have determined that for any reason adequate and reasonable means do not exist
for ascertaining the LIBOR Rate for any requested Interest Period with respect
to a LIBOR Rate Loan or that the LIBOR Rate for any requested Interest Period
with respect thereto does not adequately and fairly reflect the cost to the Bank
or any relevant Lending Office of funding such Loan, the Bank will forthwith
give notice of such determination to the relevant Borrowers. Thereafter, the
obligation of the Bank or any relevant Lending Office to make or continue LIBOR
Rate Loans or to convert Base Rate Loans to LIBOR Rate Loans hereunder, as the
case may be, shall be suspended until the Bank revokes such notice in writing.
Upon receipt of such notice, the relevant Borrower may revoke any notice of
borrowing or notice of conversion or continuation then submitted by it. If the
relevant Borrower does not revoke such notice with respect to a LIBOR Rate Loan,
the Bank shall make, convert or continue the Loan, as proposed by such Borrower,
in the amount specified in the applicable notice submitted by such Borrower, but
such Loan shall be made, converted or continued as a Base Rate Loan instead of a
LIBOR Rate Loan.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
4.06 Certificate of the Bank.06 Certificate of the Bank.06 Certificate
of the Bank.06 Certificate of the Bank. If claiming reimbursement or
compensation pursuant to this Article IV, the Bank shall deliver to each
relevant Borrower a certificate setting forth in reasonable detail the amount
payable to the Bank or any relevant Lending Office hereunder, and such
certificate shall be conclusive and binding on each recipient Borrower in the
absence of manifest error.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
4.07 Survival.
The agreements and obligations of the Borrowers in this Article IV shall
survive the payment of all other Obligations.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<PAGE>
ARTICLE V
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
CONDITIONS PRECEDENT
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
5.01 Conditions to Effectiveness of this Agreement.01 Conditions to
Effectiveness of this Agreement.01 Conditions to Effectiveness of this
Agreement.01 Conditions to Effectiveness of this Agreement. The effectiveness of
this Agreement is subject to the condition that the Bank shall have received on
or before the Effective Date all of the following, in form and substance
satisfactory to the Bank and its counsel:
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(a) Credit Agreement
This Agreement shall be duly executed and delivered by each Borrower ;
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(b) Resolutions; Incumbency
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(i) Copies of the resolutions of the board of
directors of BAX, Brink's and Pittston approving and
authorizing the execution, delivery and performance of this
Agreement, its respective Guaranty and the other Loan
Documents to be delivered by it hereunder, certified as of the
Effective Date by the Secretary or an Assistant Secretary of
such Borrower or the Guarantor, as the case may be; and
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(ii) A certificate of the Secretary or Assistant
Secretary of BAX, Brink's and Pittston as of the Effective
Date certifying the names and true signatures of the officers
of such Borrower authorized to execute and deliver this
Agreement, its respective Guaranty and all other Loan
Documents to be delivered by it hereunder.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(c) 1999 Revolving Facility. The 1999 Revolving Facility shall
have terminated or expired in accordance with its terms.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(d) Guaranties.
The Guaranties duly executed and delivered by BAX, Brink's and Pittston.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(e) Legal Opinions(e) Legal Opinions(e) Legal Opinions(e)
Legal Opinions. Opinions in form and substance reasonably satisfactory
to the Bank of the general counsel of Pittston (and in such capacity,
acting as counsel for Borrowers) and, as to matters of New York law, of
Hunton & Williams.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(f) Payment of Costs and Fees(f) Payment of Costs and Fees(f)
Payment of Costs and Fees(f) Payment of Costs and Fees. The Borrowers
shall have paid (i) all costs, accrued and unpaid fees and expenses
incurred by the Bank, to the extent due and payable on the Effective
Date, including the fees and expenses of outside counsel to the Bank,
and (ii) the arrangement fee of $115,000.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(g) Certificates.
A certificate signed by a Responsible Officer of each Borrower, dated as of
the Effective Date, stating that:
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(i) the representations and warranties made by such Person in Article VI,
and the representations and warranties made in the respective Guaranty, are true
and correct on and as of such date, as though made on and as of such date;
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(ii) no Default or Event of Default exists as of the Effective Date; and
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(iii) since December 31, 2001, there has occurred no event or circumstance
that could reasonably be expected to result in a Material Adverse Effect.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(h) Financial Statements(h) Financial Statements(h) Financial
Statements(h) Financial Statements. A copy of the audited and unaudited
financial statements of the Guarantor and its Subsidiaries referred to
in Section 6.07, accompanied by a copy of the related auditor's report,
in the case of the audited financial statements, and a certificate of a
Responsible Officer of the Guarantor, in the case of the unaudited
financial statements.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
5.02 Conditions to Subsequent Advances and Allocations.02 Conditions to
Subsequent Advances and Allocations.02 Conditions to Subsequent Advances and
Allocations.02 Conditions to Subsequent Advances and Allocations. The obligation
of the Bank to make any Advance and accept any allocation request after the
Effective Date is subject to the satisfaction of the following conditions
precedent on the date of the relevant extension of credit:
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(a) Notice of Advance or Allocation.
The Bank shall have received a notice of borrowing pursuant to Section
2.02, an allocation request pursuant to Section 2.01(b) or an L/C Application
pursuant to Section 3.03;
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(b) Continuation of Representations and Warranties(b)
Continuation of Representations and Warranties(b) Continuation of
Representations and Warranties(b) Continuation of Representations and
Warranties. The representations and warranties made by the Borrowers in
Article VI and the representations and warranties made by each
Guarantor in its Guaranty shall be true and correct on and as of the
date of such extension of credit with the same effect as if made on and
as of such date;
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(c) No Existing Default No Existing DefaultNo Existing
DefaultNo Existing Default. No Default or Event of Default shall exist
on the date of such Advance or acceptance of any allocation request or
shall result from such Advance or acceptance of any allocation request;
and
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(d) Additional Documentation.
The relevant Borrower shall have delivered any Note or other document as
the relevant Lending Office may reasonably require.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Each request for an Advance or allocation shall constitute a
representation and warranty by the requesting Borrower that, as of the date of
such request and as of the date that the Advance is made or allocation is
accepted by the Bank, the conditions in this Section 5.02 are satisfied.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
ARTICLE VI
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Each Borrower (or, as specifically provided below, Pittston only),
represents and warrants to the Bank, as follows:
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
6.01 Corporate Existence6.01 Corporate Existence.01 Corporate
Existence.01 Corporate Existence. (a) The Borrower is duly organized, validly
existing and in good standing under the laws of its jurisdiction of
incorporation; (b) the Borrower (i) has the requisite power and authority to own
its property and assets and to carry on its business as now conducted and (ii)
is qualified to do business in every jurisdiction where such qualification is
required, except where the failure so to qualify would not have a Material
Adverse Effect. The Borrower has the corporate power to execute and deliver and
to perform its obligations under the Loan Documents to which it is party and to
borrow hereunder and to provide its Guaranty.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
6.02 Non-Contravention6.02 Non-Contravention.02 Non-Contravention.02
Non-Contravention. The execution, delivery and performance by the Borrower of
the Loan Documents to which it is party have been duly authorized by all
necessary corporate action and do not and will not (i) require any consent or
approval of the shareholders of the Borrower, (ii) violate any provision of any
law, rule, regulation (including, without limitation, Regulation G, U or X of
the Federal Reserve Board), order, writ, judgment, injunction, decree,
determination, or award presently in effect having applicability to the Borrower
or of the charter or by-laws of the Borrower, (iii) result in a material breach
of or constitute a material default under any indenture or loan or credit
agreement or any other agreement, lease, or instrument to which the Borrower is
a party or by which it or its properties may be bound or affected, or (iv)
result in the creation of a Lien of any nature upon or with respect to any of
the properties now owned or hereafter acquired by the Borrower; and the Borrower
is not in default under any such order, writ, judgment, injunction, decree,
determination, or award or any such indenture, agreement, lease, or instrument
or in default under any such law, rule, or regulation, which default would have
a Material Adverse Effect.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
6.03 No Consent6.03 No Consent.03 No Consent.03 No Consent. No
authorization, consent, approval, license, exemption of, or filing or
registration with, or any other action in respect of any Governmental Authority
is or will be necessary for the valid execution, delivery or performance by the
Borrower of the Loan Documents to which it is party.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
6.04 Binding Obligations6.04 Binding Obligations.04 Binding
Obligations.04 Binding Obligations.. Each of the Loan Documents to which the
Borrower is party constitute legal, valid, and binding obligations of the
Borrower enforceable against the Borrower in accordance with their respective
terms, except as enforceability may be limited by applicable bankruptcy,
insolvency or similar laws affecting the enforcement of creditors' rights
generally or by equitable principles relating to enforceability.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
6.05 Title to Properties6.05 Title to Properties.05 Title to
Properties.05 Title to Properties. The Borrower has good and marketable title to
all of the material assets and properties purported to be owned by it, free and
clear of all liens except those permitted by the Pittston Credit Agreement.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
6.06 Subsidiaries6.06 Subsidiaries.06 Subsidiaries.06 Subsidiaries. As
of the Effective Date, each BAX Subsidiary listed on Schedule A-1 is a
Subsidiary of BAX, each Brink's Subsidiary listed on Schedule A-2 is a
Subsidiary of Brink's, and all of such Subsidiaries' shares which are owned,
directly or indirectly, by BAX or Brink's have been duly authorized and validly
issued, are fully paid and nonassessable and are free and clear of any Lien.
Pittston represents and warrants that no member of the Pittston Minerals Group
is direct or indirect Subsidiary of BAX or Brink's and agrees that it will not
request that any be added as a Covered Subsidiary on Schedule B-1.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
6.07 Financial Statements.
Pittston hereby represents and warrants that:
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(a) The consolidated balance sheet of Pittston and its
Subsidiaries as at December 31, 2001, and the related consolidated
statements of operations, shareholders' equity and cash flows for the
year then ended, certified by KPMG Peat Marwick, independent public
accountants, copies of which will be delivered to the Bank on the
Effective Date, fairly present in all material respects the
consolidated financial condition of Pittston and its Subsidiaries as at
such date and the consolidated results of their operations for the year
then ended, all prepared in accordance with GAAP applied on a
consistent basis.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(b) The unaudited consolidated balance sheet of Pittston and
its Subsidiaries as at September 30, 2002, the related unaudited
consolidated statement of operations of Pittston and its Subsidiaries
for the fiscal quarter year then ended, and the related unaudited
consolidated statement of cash flows of Pittston and its Subsidiaries
for the fiscal quarter then ended, copies of which will be delivered to
the Bank on the Effective Date, fairly present in all material respects
the consolidated financial condition of Pittston and its Subsidiaries
as at such date and their consolidated results of operations for the
quarter then ended, all prepared in accordance with GAAP (except for
the omission of notes and subject to year-end adjustments) applied on a
consistent basis; and there has been no material adverse change in such
condition or operations since September 30, 2002.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
6.08 Litigation6.08 Litigation.08 Litigation.08 Litigation. Except as
otherwise disclosed in writing to the Bank, including through the delivery to
the Bank of copies of reports and statements filed by Pittston with the
Securities and Exchange Commission, there are no material actions, suits, or
proceedings pending or, to the knowledge of the Borrower, threatened against or
affecting the Borrower or the properties of the Borrower before any Governmental
Authority or arbitrator, and the Borrower is not in default (in any respect
which might have a material adverse effect on the ability of the Borrower to
perform its obligations under the Loan Documents to which it is party) with
respect to any law, rule, regulation, order, writ, judgment, injunction, decree,
determination or award presently in effect and applicable to the Borrower.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
6.09 Taxes6.09 Taxes.09 Taxes.09 Taxes. The Borrower has filed all
material tax returns (federal, state, and local) required to be filed and paid
all taxes shown thereon to be due, including interest and penalties, or provided
adequate reserves, in accordance with GAAP, for the payment thereof.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
6.10 ERISA6.10 ERISA.10 ERISA.10 ERISA. Each Plan has complied with and
has been administered in all material respects in accordance with the applicable
provisions of ERISA and the Code. No Plan has terminated under circumstances
giving rise to liability of the Borrower of any ERISA Affiliate to the PBGC
under Section 4062, 4063 or 4064 of ERISA, which liability remains unpaid in
whole or in part, and no lien under Section 4068 of ERISA exists with respect to
the assets of the Borrower. No Reportable Event has occurred with respect to any
Plan, except for Reportable Events previously disclosed in writing to the Bank
that would not have a Material Adverse Effect. No accumulated funding deficiency
within the meaning of Section 302 of ERISA or Section 412 of the Code (whether
or not waived) exists with respect to any Plan, nor does any lien under Section
302 of ERISA or Section 412 of the Code exist with respect to any Plan.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Neither the Borrower nor any ERISA Affiliate has completely or
partially withdrawn from any one or more Multiemployer Plans under circumstances
which would give rise to withdrawal liability which, in the aggregate, could
have a Material Adverse Effect and which has not been fully paid as of the date
hereof. Neither the Borrower nor any ERISA Affiliate has received notice that
any Multiemployer Plan is in reorganization (within the meaning of Section 4241
of ERISA), is insolvent (within the meaning of Section 4245 of ERISA), or has
terminated under Title IV of ERISA, nor, to the best knowledge of the Borrower,
is any such reorganization, insolvency or termination reasonably likely to
occur, where such reorganization, insolvency or termination has resulted or can
reasonably be expected to result in an increase in the contributions required to
be made to such Multiemployer Plan in an amount that would have a Material
Adverse Effect. Neither the Borrower nor any ERISA Affiliate has failed to make
any contribution to a Multiemployer Plan which is required under ERISA or an
applicable collective bargaining agreement in an amount which is material in the
aggregate (except to the extent there is a good faith dispute as to whether any
contribution is owed, the amount owed or the existence of facts that would give
rise to a withdrawal).
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
6.11 No Default
The Borrower represents and warrants that no Default and no Event of
Default has occurred and is continuing.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
6.12 Federal Reserve Regulations.
(a) The Borrower is not engaged principally, or as one of its important
activities, in the business of extending credit for the purpose of purchasing or
carrying Margin Stock.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(b) No part of the proceeds of any Advances will be used, whether directly
or indirectly, and whether immediately, incidentally or ultimately, for any
purpose which entails a violation of, or which is inconsistent with, the
provisions of the Regulations promulgated by the Federal Reserve Board,
including, without limitation, Regulations G, U or X.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
6.13 Investment Company Act6.13 Investment Company Act.13 Investment
Company Act.13 Investment Company Act. None of the Borrowers is an "investment
company" as defined in, or subject to regulation under, the Investment Company
Act of 1940.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
6.14 Environmental Matters6.14 Environmental Matters.14 Environmental
Matters.14 Environmental Matters. In the ordinary course of its business,
Pittston conducts an ongoing review of the effect of Environmental Laws and laws
relating to occupational safety and health on the business, operations and
properties of Pittston and its Subsidiaries, in the course of which it
identifies and evaluates associated liabilities and costs (including any capital
or operating expenditures required for clean-up, closure or restoration of
properties presently or previously owned, any capital or operating expenditures
required to achieve or maintain compliance with environmental protection and
occupational health and safety standards imposed by law or as a condition of any
license, permit or contact, any related constraints on operating activities,
including any periodic or permanent shutdown of any facility or reduction in the
level of or change in the nature of operations conducted thereat and any actual
or potential liabilities to third parties, including employees, and any related
costs and expenses). On the basis of this review, each Borrower represents and
warrants that applicable Environmental Laws and laws relating to occupational
health and safety do not have a material adverse effect on its business,
financial condition or results of operations, and it has obtained and holds all
material permits, licenses and approvals required under Environmental Laws which
are necessary for the conduct of its business and the operation of its
facilities, and it has not received any written notice of any failure to be in
compliance with the terms and conditions of such permits, licenses and
approvals, which failure could reasonably be expected to have a material adverse
effect on it.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
6.15 Priority of Debt6.15 Priority of Debt.15 Priority of Debt.15
Priority of Debt. Each Borrower hereby represents and warrants that all Debt
created under this Agreement for which it is or may be liable ranks pari passu
with all other Debt for borrowed money which such person owes or may be liable
for to any Person other than the Bank.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
ARTICLE VII
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
COVENANTS
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
7.01 Affirmative Covenants7.01 Affirmative Covenants.01 Affirmative
Covenants.01 Affirmative Covenants. For the benefit of the Bank, so long as any
Advance remains outstanding hereunder or the Commitment remains in effect, each
Borrower shall, unless the Bank otherwise consents in writing:
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(a) Payment of Taxes, etc.(a) Payment of Taxes, etc.(a)
Payment of Taxes, etc.(a) Payment of Taxes, etc. Pay and discharge all
taxes, assessments and governmental charges or levies imposed upon it
or upon its income or profits, or upon any properties belonging to it,
prior to the date on which penalties attach thereto, and all lawful
claims which, if unpaid, might become a lien or charge upon any of its
properties; provided, however, that neither it shall not be required to
pay any such tax, assessment, charge, levy or claim which is being
contested in good faith and by proper proceedings and against which it
is maintaining adequate reserves in accordance with GAAP.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(b) Maintenance of Insurance(b) Maintenance of Insurance(b)
Maintenance of Insurance(b) Maintenance of Insurance. Maintain, and
cause each Restricted Subsidiary to maintain, insurance with
responsible and reputable insurance companies or associations (or, to
the extent consistent with prudent business practice, through its own
program of self-insurance) in such amounts and covering such risks as
is usually carried by companies engaged in similar businesses and
owning similar properties in the same general areas in which it
operates.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(c) Preservation of Corporate Existence, etc.8 Preservation of
Corporate Existence, etc. Preservation of Corporate Existence,
etc.Preservation of Corporate Existence, etc. Preserve and maintain its
corporate existence, rights, franchises and privileges in the
jurisdiction of its incorporation; provided, however, that nothing
herein contained shall prevent any merger or consolidation permitted by
Section 7.03(ii).
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(d) Compliance with Laws, etc.(d) Compliance with Laws,
etc.(d) Compliance with Laws, etc.(d) Compliance with Laws, etc. Comply
with the requirements of all applicable laws, rules, regulations and
orders (other than laws, rules, regulations, and orders which are not
final and are being contested in good faith by proper proceedings) of
any Governmental Authority (including Labor Laws and Environmental
Laws) applicable to or binding upon it or its property, noncompliance
with which would materially adversely affect its business or credit.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(e) Compliance with ERISA(e) Compliance with ERISA(e)
Compliance with ERISA(e) Compliance with ERISA. Comply with the minimum
funding standards under ERISA with respect to its Plans and use its
best efforts to comply in all material respects with all other
applicable provisions of ERISA and the regulations and interpretations
promulgated thereunder.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(f) Access to Properties(f) Access to Properties(f) Access to
Properties(f) Access to Properties. Permit any representatives
designated by the Bank, upon reasonable prior notice to it, to visit
its properties at reasonable times and as often as reasonably
requested.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(g) Use of Proceeds(g) Use of Proceeds(g) Use of Proceeds(g)
Use of Proceeds. Use the Advances, and any proceeds thereof, for
working capital and other general corporate purposes not in
contravention of any Requirement of Law or the provisions of Section
6.12(b).
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
7.02 Negative Covenants.02 Negative Covenants.02 Negative Covenants.02
Negative Covenants. So long as any Advance remains outstanding hereunder or any
of the Commitment remains in effect, Pittston will not, unless the Bank
otherwise consents in writing:
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(a) Financial Covenants.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(i) Maximum Leverage Ratio. Commencing with the end of the first fiscal
quarter ending after the date hereof, permit the Leverage Ratio as of the end of
each fiscal quarter to be greater than 55%.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(ii) Minimum Interest Coverage Ratio. Commencing with the end of the first
fiscal quarter ending after the date hereof, permit the Interest Coverage Ratio
as of the end of each fiscal quarter to be less than 3.00 to 1.00.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(b) Limitations on Liens.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Create, incur, assume or suffer to exist, or permit any
Restricted Subsidiary to create, incur, assume or suffer to exist, any
Lien on, or with respect to, any of their assets or properties
(including without limitation shares of capital stock or other
ownership interests), real or personal, whether now owned or hereafter
acquired, except:
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(i) Liens existing on the date hereof and set forth on Schedule 9.2 to the
Pittston Agreement;
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(ii) Liens for taxes, assessments and other governmental charges or levies
not yet due or as to which the period of grace, if any, related thereto has not
expired or which are being contested in good faith and by appropriate
proceedings if adequate reserves are maintained to the extent required by GAAP;
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(iii) The claims of materialmen, mechanics, carriers, warehousemen,
processors or landlords for labor, materials, supplies or rentals incurred in
the ordinary course of business, (A) which are not overdue for a period of more
than thirty (30) days or (B) which are being contested in good faith and by
appropriate proceedings if adequate reserves are maintained to the extent
required by GAAP;
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(iv) Liens consisting of deposits or pledges made in the ordinary course of
business (A) in connection with, or to secure payment of, obligations under
workers' compensation, unemployment insurance or similar legislation or
obligations under customer service contracts, or (B) to secure (or to obtain
letters of credit that secure) the performance of tenders, statutory
obligations, surety bonds, appeal bonds, bids, leases (other than Capital
Leases), performance bonds, purchase, construction or sales contracts and other
similar obligations, in each case not incurred or made in connection with the
borrowing of money, the obtaining of advances or credit or the payment of the
deferred purchase price of property.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(v) Liens constituting encumbrances in the nature of zoning
restrictions, easements and rights or restrictions of record on the use
of real property, which in the aggregate are not substantial in amount
and which do not, in any case, detract from the value of any material
parcel of real property or impair the use thereof in the ordinary
conduct of business.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(vi) Liens in favor of the Bank;
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(vii) Liens on the property or assets of any Restricted
Subsidiary existing at the time such Restricted Subsidiary becomes a
Subsidiary of a Borrower and not incurred in contemplation thereof, as
long as the outstanding principal amount of the Debt secured thereby is
not voluntarily increased by such Restricted Subsidiary after the date
such Restricted Subsidiary becomes a Subsidiary of Borrower;
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(viii) Liens on the property or assets of the Borrowers or any
Restricted Subsidiary securing Debt which is incurred to finance the
acquisition of such property or assets, provided that (A) each such
Lien shall be created simultaneously with, or within twelve months
after, the acquisition of the related property or assets; (B) each such
Lien does not at any time encumber any property other than the related
property or assets financed by such Debt; (C) the principal amount of
Debt secured by each such Lien is not increased; and (D) the principal
amount of Debt secured by each such Lien shall at no time exceed 100%
of the original purchase price of such related property or assets at
the time acquired.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(ix) Liens consisting of judgment or judicial attachment Liens, provided
that (A) the claims giving rise to such Liens are being diligently contested in
good faith by appropriate proceedings, (B) adequate reserves for the obligations
secured by such Liens have been established and (C) enforcement of such Liens
has been stayed;
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(x) Liens created or deemed to exist in connection with any asset
securitization program (including any related filings of any financing
statements), but only to the extent that such Liens attach to the assets
actually sold, contributed, financed or otherwise conveyed or pledged in
connection with such securitization program;
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(xi) Liens on property or assets of any Borrower or any Restricted
Subsidiary securing indebtedness owing to any Borrower;
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(xii) Liens on coal reserves leased by any Borrower or by any Restricted
Subsidiary as lessee, securing Debt to the lessors thereof, arising out of such
leases; (xiii) Liens on any Margin Stock purchased or carried by Pittston or any
of its Subsidiaries;
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(xiv) The extension, renewal or replacement of any Lien
permitted by clauses (i), (vii), (viii) or (xii), but only if the
principal amount of Debt secured by the Lien immediately prior thereto
is not increased and the Lien is not extended to other property; and
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(xv) In addition to any Lien permitted by clauses (i) through
(xiv), immediately after giving effect to any concurrent repayment of
secured Debt, Liens securing Debt of Pittston or any Restricted
Subsidiary so long as the sum of (A) the aggregate principal amount of
all such secured Debt plus (B) the aggregate amount of Consolidated
Lease Rentals (excluding Consolidated Lease Rentals under Leases in
effect as of December 31, 2001 (and any renewal, extension, or
replacement thereof) and Leases with respect to property not owned by
the Borrower on such date), discounted to present value at ten percent
(10%), compounded annually, arising out of all Sale and Leaseback
Transactions to which Pittston or any of its Restricted Subsidiaries is
then a party (including Sale and Leaseback Transactions, if any,
entered into pursuant to Section 7.02(i)), does not exceed 10% of
Consolidated Net Worth; provided that the sale or transfer of (x) coal,
oil, gas or other minerals in place for a period of time until, or in
an amount such that, the transferee will realize therefrom a specified
amount of money (however determined) or a specified amount of such coal
or other minerals or (y) any other interest in property of the
character commonly referred to as a "production payment" shall not be
deemed to constitute Debt secured by a Lien.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(c) Disposition of Debt and Shares of Restricted Subsidiaries; Issuance of
Shares by Restricted Subsidiaries; Consolidation, Merger or Disposition of
Assets.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(i) Sell or otherwise dispose of, or permit any Restricted
Subsidiary to sell or otherwise dispose of, any capital stock or any
Debt of any Restricted Subsidiary, other than the sale of the capital
stock of any member of the Pittston Minerals Group, (ii) in the case of
any Restricted Subsidiary, issue, sell or otherwise dispose of any of
such Restricted Subsidiary's capital stock (other than directors'
qualifying shares, to satisfy preemptive rights or in connection with a
split or combination of shares or a dividend in shares) except to the
Borrower or another Restricted Subsidiary, (iii) liquidate, wind-up or
dissolve itself (or suffer any liquidation or dissolution) or permit
any Restricted Subsidiary to liquidate, wind-up or dissolve itself (or
suffer any liquidation or dissolution), or (iv) directly or indirectly,
or permit any Restricted Subsidiary to directly or indirectly,
consolidate with or merge with or into or sell, lease or otherwise
dispose of all or substantially all of its assets (other than the sale
of all or any part of the assets of any member of the Pittston Minerals
Group) to any Person, unless, after giving effect thereto, all of the
following conditions shall be met:
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(A) the Leverage Ratio shall not be greater than .55
to 1.00 and the Interest Coverage Ratio shall not be less than
3.00 to 1.00;
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(B) in the case of a merger or consolidation (x) if
Pittston is a party thereto, Pittston shall be the surviving
corporation, (y) if Pittston is not a party thereto and
another Borrower is a party thereto, a Borrower shall be the
surviving corporation and (z) if no Borrower is a party
thereto, a Restricted Subsidiary shall be the surviving
corporation;
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(C) in the case of a liquidation, winding-up or
dissolution, any Borrower (other than Pittston) or any
Restricted Subsidiary may liquidate, wind-up or dissolve
itself into a Borrower or a Restricted Subsidiary; and
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(D) no Default or Event of Default has occurred and
is continuing.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Provided that the conditions of this Section 7.02(c) are satisfied,
none of the foregoing provisions shall be deemed to prohibit Pittston
or any of its Restricted Subsidiaries from selling, transferring
assigning or otherwise disposing of Margin Stock for fair market value
or selling, contributing, financing or otherwise conveying or pledging
assets in connection with any asset securitization program permitted by
Section 7.02(b)(x).
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(d) Transactions with Affiliates.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Engage, or permit any Restricted Subsidiary to engage,
directly or indirectly, in any transaction with an Affiliate (other
than a Borrower) on terms more favorable to the Affiliate than would
have been obtainable in arm's-length dealing.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(e) Compliance with Regulations T, U and X.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
In the case of Pittston and any Subsidiary of the Borrower,
purchase or carry any Margin Stock or incur, create or assume any
obligation for borrowed money or other liability or make any
investment, capital contribution, loan, advance or extension of credit
or sell or otherwise dispose of any assets or pay any dividend or make
any other distribution to its shareholders or take or permit to be
taken any other action or permit to occur or exist any event or
condition if such action, event or condition would result in this
Agreement, the Loans, the use of the proceeds thereof or the other
transactions contemplated hereby violating Regulation T, U or X.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(f) Hedging Agreements.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Enter into or permit any Restricted Subsidiary to enter into
or permit to exist, Hedging Agreements for the purpose of speculation
and not for the purpose of hedging risks associated with the businesses
of Pittston and its Restricted Subsidiaries.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(g) ERISA.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(i) Terminate, or permit any of its ERISA Affiliates to
terminate any Pension Plan under circumstances which would reasonably
result in a material liability of the Borrower or any ERISA Affiliate
to the PBGC, or permit to exist the occurrence of any Reportable Event
or any other event or condition which presents a material risk of such
a termination by the PBGC; (ii) engage, or permit any of its
Subsidiaries or any Pension Plan to engage, in a "prohibited
transaction" (within the meaning of Section 406 of ERISA or Section
4975 of the Code) that would reasonably result in material liability of
the Borrower or any of its Restricted Subsidiaries; (iii) fail, or
permit any of its Restricted Subsidiaries to fail, to make any
contribution to a Multiemployer Plan which is required by ERISA or an
applicable collective bargaining agreement in an amount which is
material (except to the extent there is a good faith dispute as to
whether any contribution is owed, the amount owed or the existence of
facts that would give rise to a withdrawal); or (iv) completely or
partially withdraw, or permit any of its ERISA Affiliates to completely
or partially withdraw from a Multiemployer Plan, if such complete or
partial withdrawal will result in any material withdrawal liability
under Title IV of ERISA; or (v) enter into any new Plan or modify any
existing Plan so as to increase its obligations thereunder which could
result in any material liability to the Borrower or any ERISA
Affiliate. For purposes of this Section 7.02(g), an amount is material
if it would have a Material Adverse Effect after aggregation with all
other liabilities described in this Section 7.02(g).
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(h) Limitations on Acquisitions.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Acquire, or permit any Restricted Subsidiary to acquire, all
or any portion of the capital stock or other ownership interest in any
Person which is not then a Restricted Subsidiary or any assets
collectively constituting a business unit of a Person which is not then
a Restricted Subsidiary, unless:
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(i) the aggregate consideration paid by the acquiror in such
transaction does not exceed 20% of Consolidated Total Assets as of the
end of the Fiscal Year most recently ended; or
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(ii) in the event that the aggregate consideration to be paid
by the acquiror in such transaction exceeds 20% of Consolidated Total
Assets as of the end of the Fiscal Year most recently ended, (A)
Pittston shall have notified the Bank at least five Business Days prior
to the consummation thereof that such an acquisition is pending
(furnishing with such information reasonably acceptable to the Bank
demonstrating pro forma compliance with the financial covenants set
forth in Section 7.02(a)), and (B) after giving effect to such
acquisition on a pro forma basis, no Default or Event of Default would
exist under Section 7.02(a). Any notice delivered to the Bank pursuant
to this Section 7.02(h) shall be kept confidential by the Bank in
accordance with Section 9.08 below.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(i) Sale Leaseback Transactions.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Sell or transfer, or permit any Restricted Subsidiaries to
sell or transfer, any material property or assets owned by Pittston or
any Restricted Subsidiary on the date hereof to any Person (other than
any Borrower) with the intention of taking back a lease of such
property or assets or any similar property or assets, if the sum of (A)
the amount of Consolidated Lease Rentals, discounted to present value
at 10%, compounded annually, which would arise out of such proposed
Sale and Leaseback Transaction, plus (B) the aggregate amount of
Consolidated Lease Rentals (excluding Consolidated Lease Rentals under
Leases in effect as of December 31, 2001 (and any renewal, extension or
replacement thereof) and Leases with respect to property not owned by
the Borrower on such date), discounted to present value at ten percent
(10%), compounded annually, arising out of all other Sale and Leaseback
Transactions to which Pittston or any of its Restricted Subsidiaries is
then a party, plus (C) the aggregate principal amount of all Debt of
Pittston or any Restricted Subsidiary secured by Liens incurred in
reliance on Section 7.02(b)(o), would exceed 15% of Consolidated Net
Worth.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
7.03 Reporting Requirements of PittstonSell or transfer, or permit any
Restricted Subsidiaries to sell or transfer, any material property or assets
owned by Pittston or any Restricted Subsidiary on the date hereof to any Person
(other than any Borrower) with the intention of taking back a lease of such
property or assets or any similar property or assets, if the sum of (A) the
amount of Consolidated Lease Rentals, discounted to present value at 10%,
compounded annually, which would arise out of such proposed Sale and Leaseback
Transaction, plus (B) the aggregate amount of Consolidated Lease Rentals
(excluding Consolidated Lease Rentals under Leases in effect as of December 31,
2001 (and any renewal, extension or replacement thereof) and Leases with respect
to property not owned by the Borrower on such date), discounted to present value
at ten percent (10%), compounded annually, arising out of all other Sale and
Leaseback Transactions to which Pittston or any of its Restricted Subsidiaries
is then a party, plus 8 the aggregate principal amount of all Debt of Pittston
or any Restricted Subsidiary secured by Liens incurred in reliance on Section
7.02(b)(o), would exceed 15% of Consolidated Net Worth.(j) Limitations on
Investments.Make or permit to exist, or permit any Restricted Subsidiary to make
or permit to exist, any Investment, other than Investments which are:(i) cash
and Cash Equivalents;(ii) current assets generated in the ordinary course of
business;(iii) accounts receivable created, acquired or made in the ordinary
course of business and payable or dischargeable in accordance with customary
trade terms;(iv) Investments consisting of capital stock, obligations,
securities or other property received in settlement of accounts receivable
(created in the ordinary course of business) from bankrupt obligors;(v) advances
to employees for moving and travel expenses, drawing accounts and similar
expenditures in the ordinary course of business;(vi) advances or loans to
directors, officers and employees that do not exceed $25,000,000 in the
aggregate at any one time outstanding;(vii) advances or loans to customers and
suppliers in the ordinary course of business in an aggregate amount consistent
with the past practice of the Person making such advance or loan;(viii) loans to
shareholders intended to constitute dividends on, or payment on account of, any
capital stock;(ix) Investments or Support Obligations by Pittston and its
Restricted Subsidiaries existing on the date hereof;(x) Investments by Pittston
or its Restricted Subsidiaries in any Borrower or any other Subsidiary (provided
that such Investment would not otherwise constitute a breach of Section
7.02(h));(xi) Support Obligations of Pittston or its Restricted Subsidiaries for
the benefit of any Borrower or any other Subsidiary;(xii) acquisitions permitted
by Section 7.02(h) and Investments consisting of capital stock, obligations,
securities or other property received in connection with any merger or sale
permitted by Section 7.02(o);(xiii) Investments in connection with the
management of Pension Plans and other benefit plans of Pittston and its
Subsidiaries (including without limitation The Pittston Company Employee Welfare
Benefit Trust);(xiv) Hedging Agreements permitted by Section 7.02(b); and(xv)
Investments of a nature not contemplated in the foregoing subsections in an
amount not to exceed 15% of Consolidated Net Worth.7.03 Reporting Requirements
of PittstonSell or transfer, or permit any Restricted Subsidiaries to sell or
transfer, any material property or assets owned by Pittston or any Restricted
Subsidiary on the date hereof to any Person (other than any Borrower) with the
intention of taking back a lease of such property or assets or any similar
property or assets, if the sum of (A) the amount of Consolidated Lease Rentals,
discounted to present value at 10%, compounded annually, which would arise out
of such proposed Sale and Leaseback Transaction, plus (B) the aggregate amount
of Consolidated Lease Rentals (excluding Consolidated Lease Rentals under Leases
in effect as of December 31, 2001 (and any renewal, extension or replacement
thereof) and Leases with respect to property not owned by the Borrower on such
date), discounted to present value at ten percent (10%), compounded annually,
arising out of all other Sale and Leaseback Transactions to which Pittston or
any of its Restricted Subsidiaries is then a party, plus 8 the aggregate
principal amount of all Debt of Pittston or any Restricted Subsidiary secured by
Liens incurred in reliance on Section 7.02(b)(o), would exceed 15% of
Consolidated Net Worth.(j) Limitations on Investments.Make or permit to exist,
or permit any Restricted Subsidiary to make or permit to exist, any Investment,
other than Investments which are:(i) cash and Cash Equivalents;(ii) current
assets generated in the ordinary course of business;(iii) accounts receivable
created, acquired or made in the ordinary course of business and payable or
dischargeable in accordance with customary trade terms;(iv) Investments
consisting of capital stock, obligations, securities or other property received
in settlement of accounts receivable (created in the ordinary course of
business) from bankrupt obligors;(v) advances to employees for moving and travel
expenses, drawing accounts and similar expenditures in the ordinary course of
business;(vi) advances or loans to directors, officers and employees that do not
exceed $25,000,000 in the aggregate at any one time outstanding;(vii) advances
or loans to customers and suppliers in the ordinary course of business in an
aggregate amount consistent with the past practice of the Person making such
advance or loan;(viii) loans to shareholders intended to constitute dividends
on, or payment on account of, any capital stock;(ix) Investments or Support
Obligations by Pittston and its Restricted Subsidiaries existing on the date
hereof;(x) Investments by Pittston or its Restricted Subsidiaries in any
Borrower or any other Subsidiary (provided that such Investment would not
otherwise constitute a breach of Section 7.02(h));(xi) Support Obligations of
Pittston or its Restricted Subsidiaries for the benefit of any Borrower or any
other Subsidiary;(xii) acquisitions permitted by Section 7.02(h) and Investments
consisting of capital stock, obligations, securities or other property received
in connection with any merger or sale permitted by Section 7.02(o);(xiii)
Investments in connection with the management of Pension Plans and other benefit
plans of Pittston and its Subsidiaries (including without limitation The
Pittston Company Employee Welfare Benefit Trust);(xiv) Hedging Agreements
permitted by Section 7.02(b); and(xv) Investments of a nature not contemplated
in the foregoing subsections in an amount not to exceed 15% of Consolidated Net
Worth.7.03 Reporting Requirements of PittstonSell or transfer, or permit any
Restricted Subsidiaries to sell or transfer, any material property or assets
owned by Pittston or any Restricted Subsidiary on the date hereof to any Person
(other than any Borrower) with the intention of taking back a lease of such
property or assets or any similar property or assets, if the sum of (A) the
amount of Consolidated Lease Rentals, discounted to present value at 10%,
compounded annually, which would arise out of such proposed Sale and Leaseback
Transaction, plus (B) the aggregate amount of Consolidated Lease Rentals
(excluding Consolidated Lease Rentals under Leases in effect as of December 31,
2001 (and any renewal, extension or replacement thereof) and Leases with respect
to property not owned by the Borrower on such date), discounted to present value
at ten percent (10%), compounded annually, arising out of all other Sale and
Leaseback Transactions to which Pittston or any of its Restricted Subsidiaries
is then a party, plus 8 the aggregate principal amount of all Debt of Pittston
or any Restricted Subsidiary secured by Liens incurred in reliance on Section
7.02(b)(o), would exceed 15% of Consolidated Net Worth.(j) Limitations on
Investments.Make or permit to exist, or permit any Restricted Subsidiary to make
or permit to exist, any Investment, other than Investments which are:(i) cash
and Cash Equivalents;(ii) current assets generated in the ordinary course of
business;(iii) accounts receivable created, acquired or made in the ordinary
course of business and payable or dischargeable in accordance with customary
trade terms;(iv) Investments consisting of capital stock, obligations,
securities or other property received in settlement of accounts receivable
(created in the ordinary course of business) from bankrupt obligors;(v) advances
to employees for moving and travel expenses, drawing accounts and similar
expenditures in the ordinary course of business;(vi) advances or loans to
directors, officers and employees that do not exceed $25,000,000 in the
aggregate at any one time outstanding;(vii) advances or loans to customers and
suppliers in the ordinary course of business in an aggregate amount consistent
with the past practice of the Person making such advance or loan;(viii) loans to
shareholders intended to constitute dividends on, or payment on account of, any
capital stock;(ix) Investments or Support Obligations by Pittston and its
Restricted Subsidiaries existing on the date hereof;(x) Investments by Pittston
or its Restricted Subsidiaries in any Borrower or any other Subsidiary (provided
that such Investment would not otherwise constitute a breach of Section
7.02(h));(xi) Support Obligations of Pittston or its Restricted Subsidiaries for
the benefit of any Borrower or any other Subsidiary;(xii) acquisitions permitted
by Section 7.02(h) and Investments consisting of capital stock, obligations,
securities or other property received in connection with any merger or sale
permitted by Section 7.02(o);(xiii) Investments in connection with the
management of Pension Plans and other benefit plans of Pittston and its
Subsidiaries (including without limitation The Pittston Company Employee Welfare
Benefit Trust);(xiv) Hedging Agreements permitted by Section 7.02(b); and(xv)
Investments of a nature not contemplated in the foregoing subsections in an
amount not to exceed 15% of Consolidated Net Worth.7.03 Reporting Requirements
of Pittston. For the benefit of the Bank, so long as any Advance remains
outstanding hereunder or the Commitment remains in effect, Pittston will, unless
the Bank otherwise consents in writing:
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(a) furnish to the Bank:
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(i) annually, as soon as available, but in any event within 120 days after
the last day of each of Pittston's fiscal years, consolidated balance sheets of
Pittston and its Subsidiaries as at the last day of such fiscal year, and the
related consolidated statements of operations, shareholders' equity and cash
flows for the fiscal year then ended, prepared in accordance with GAAP, in
reasonable detail, and setting forth in comparative form corresponding figures
from the preceding annual financial statements, certified by independent
certified public accountants of recognized national standing as fairly
presenting in all material respects the consolidated financial condition and
results of operations for Pittston and its Subsidiaries;
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(ii) as soon as available, but in any event within 60 days after the end of
each of the first three fiscal quarters of each of Pittston's fiscal years,
consolidated balance sheets as at the last day of such quarter and the related
consolidated statements of operations and cash flows for the quarter then ended,
and for the then-current fiscal year through the end of such quarter, for
Pittston and its Subsidiaries, prepared in accordance with GAAP (except for
omission of notes and subject to year-end adjustments) and setting forth in
comparative form figures for the corresponding period in the prior fiscal year,
and certified by a Responsible Officer of Pittston as fairly presenting in all
material respects the consolidated financial condition and results of operations
for Pittston and its Subsidiaries;
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(iii) at the same time as it delivers the financial statements required
under the provisions of clause (i) above, a certificate signed by a Responsible
Officer of Pittston to the effect that such Officer has made due inquiry and
that to the best of the knowledge of such Officer except as stated therein no
Default or Event of Default has occurred hereunder and that such officer has
made due inquiry and that to the best of the knowledge of such Officer except as
stated therein no default has occurred under any other agreement to which
Pittston or any Borrower is a party or by which it is bound, or by which any of
its properties or assets may be affected, which could have a Material Adverse
Effect and specifying in reasonable detail the exceptions, if any, to such
statements;
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(iv) at the same time as it delivers the financial statements required
under the provisions of clauses (i) and (ii) above, a statement of a Responsible
Officer of Pittston showing the Leverage Ratio and Interest Coverage Ratio as of
the last day of the fiscal period to which such financial statements relate;
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(v) at the same time as it delivers the financial statements required under
the provisions of clause (ii) above, a certificate signed by a Responsible
Officer of Pittston and stating that such Officer has made due inquiry and that
to the best of his knowledge no Default has occurred and is continuing, or, if
such Default has occurred and is continuing, specify the nature and extent
thereof; and
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(vi) forthwith upon the occurrence of any Default or Event of Default, a
certificate of a Responsible Officer of Pittston setting forth the details
thereof and the action which Pittston or any Borrower, as the case may be, is
taking or proposes to take with respect thereto;
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(b) furnish to the Bank, promptly after the same are
available, copies of all current reports on Form 8-K, quarterly reports
on Form 10-Q, annual reports on Form 10-K (or similar corresponding
reports) and registration statements or statements which Pittston or
any Restricted Subsidiary may be required to file with the Securities
and Exchange Commission (excluding registration statements filed
pursuant to employee stock option or benefit plans); and
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(c) furnish to the Bank, as soon as reasonably practicable
after receipt by Pittston or any of its Subsidiaries, a copy of any
written notice or claim to the effect that Pittston or any of its
Subsidiaries is liable to any Person as a result of the presence or
release of any Contaminant which claim could reasonably be expected to
have a Material Adverse Effect.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
7.04 Additional Requirements of the Guarantor and the Borrowers7.04
Additional Requirements of the Guarantor and the Borrowers.04 Additional
Requirements of the Guarantor and the Borrowers.04 Additional Requirements of
the Guarantor and the Borrowers. For the benefit of the Bank, so long as any
Advance remains outstanding hereunder or the Commitment remains in effect,
Pittston and each Borrower will, unless the Bank otherwise consents in writing:
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(a) keep proper books of record and accounts in which full,
true and correct entries in accordance with GAAP shall be made of all
dealings or transactions in relation to its business and activities;
and
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(b) furnish with reasonable promptness such other financial
information as the Bank may reasonably request, provided that no
Borrower shall be required to furnish any information that would result
in violation of any confidentiality agreement by which it is bound but,
at the request of the Bank, shall use its reasonable best efforts to
obtain a waiver of such agreement to permit furnishing of such
information under this provision.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
ARTICLE VIII
EVENTS OF DEFAULT
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
8.01 Event of Default
Any of the following shall constitute an "Event of Default":
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(a) Non-Payment.
Any Borrower fails to pay (i) when and as required to be paid herein, any
amount of principal of any Loan, any Reimbursement Obligation, or (ii) within
three (3) business days after the same shall become due, any interest, fee or
any other amount payable hereunder or pursuant to any other Loan Document to
which such Borrower is a party;
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(b) Breach of Representation or Warranty. Any representation or warranty by
any Borrower or any Guarantor made or deemed made herein or in any other Loan
Document, or which is contained in any certificate, document or financial or
other statement by any Borrower or any Guarantor, or their respective
Responsible Officers, furnished at any time under this Agreement, or in or under
any other Loan Document, shall prove to have been incorrect in any material
respect on or as of the date made or deemed made;
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(c) Other Defaults. Any Borrower or any Guarantor fails to perform or
observe any other term or covenant contained in this Agreement or any other Loan
Document, and such default shall continue unremedied for a period of 30 days
after the earlier of (i) the date upon which a Responsible Officer of such
Borrower or any Guarantor gives written notice of such failure to the Bank or
(ii) the date upon which written notice thereof is given to such Borrower or any
Guarantor by the Bank;
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(d) Insolvency; Voluntary Proceedings. Any Guarantor or any Borrower (i)
ceases or fails to be solvent, or generally fails to pay, or admits in writing
its inability to pay, its debts as they become due, subject to applicable grace
periods, if any, whether at stated maturity or otherwise; (ii) voluntarily
ceases operations as a going concern; (iii) commences any Insolvency Proceeding
with respect to itself; or (iv) takes any action to effectuate or authorize any
of the foregoing;
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(e) Involuntary Proceedings. (i) Any involuntary Insolvency Proceeding is
commenced or filed against any Guarantor or any Borrower, or any writ, judgment,
warrant of attachment, execution or similar process, is issued or levied against
a substantial part of the property of any Guarantor, any Borrower or any of
their respective Subsidiaries, and any such proceeding or petition shall not be
dismissed, or such writ, judgment, warrant of attachment, execution or similar
process shall not be released, vacated or fully bonded within 60 days after
commencement, filing or levy; (ii) any Guarantor, any Borrower or any of their
respective Subsidiaries admits the material allegations of a petition against it
in any Insolvency Proceeding, or an order for relief (or similar order under the
laws of any jurisdiction other than the United States of America or a political
subdivision thereof) is ordered in any Insolvency Proceeding; or (iii) any
Guarantor, any Borrower or any of their respective Subsidiaries acquiesces in
the appointment of a receiver, trustee, custodian, conservator, liquidator,
mortgagee in possession (or agent therefor), or other similar Person for itself
or a substantial portion of its property or business;
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(f) Monetary Judgments. One or more final (non-interlocutory) and
nonappealable judgments, orders or decrees shall be entered against any
Borrower, any Guarantor or any of their respective Subsidiaries involving in the
aggregate a liability (not fully covered by insurance) as to any single or
related series of transactions, incidents or conditions that have a reasonable
likelihood of having a Material Adverse Effect (which, solely for the purposes
hereof, shall be deemed to mean at least $25,000,000 ) and the same shall remain
undischarged, unvacated and unstayed pending appeal for a period of 30 days
after the entry thereof;
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(g) Guarantor Defaults. Any Guarantor shall fail in any material respect to
perform or observe any term, covenant or agreement herein or in its Guaranty; or
any Guaranty shall for any reason be partially (including with respect to future
advances) or wholly revoked or invalidated, or otherwise cease to be in full
force and effect, or any Guarantor or any other Person shall contest in any
manner the validity or enforceability thereof or deny that it has any further
liability or obligation thereunder; or
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(h) Guarantor Cross-Acceleration. There shall be any default under any
agreement or instrument evidencing or securing Debt of any Borrower or any
Guarantor (including, without limitation, Debt incurred under the Pittston
Credit Agreement), if the effect of such default is to permit the holder or
holders of such Debt (or a trustee on its or their behalf) to cause, and such
holder or holders (or trustee) do cause, such Debt to become due prior to its
stated maturity, and the aggregate amount of such Debt so accelerated equals or
exceeds $25,000,000 (or the equivalent thereof).
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(i) Payment Cross-Defaults. Any Borrower or the Guarantor shall default in
the payment when due, after giving